The Nepalese Version of the Suśrutasaṃhitā, Śārīrasthāna, based on the Nepalese MSS, new edition (NE)

Published in 2020-2022 by The Suśruta Project in The University of Alberta.

  • Siglum: NE

hhtolxmlrp
  • NE
  • A₁₉₃₁
  • K
  • N
  • H
  • L

[Śārīrasthāna]

[Adhyāya 1. Draft based on MS H]

1931 ed. 3.1.1 athātaḥ sarvvabhūtacintāṃ śārīraṃ vyākhyāsyāmaḥ ||
Lsarvabhūtañ cintāśā° A₁₉₃₁°cintāśārīraṃ Kvyākhyāsyāmaḥ ||
From here on, the text is a duplicate of NAK 5-333, waiting to be edited. KL699 is a witness only for the first line, above.
K A₁₉₃₁add yathovāca bhagavān dhanvantariḥ || Ladd athovāca bhagavān dhanvantaritaḥ |
1931 ed. 3.1.3 sarvvabhūtānāṅ kāraṇam akāraṇaṃ satvarajastamolakṣaṇam aṣṭarūpam akhilasyāsya jagataḥ sambhavahetur avyaktannāma || tad ekam anekeṣāṃ kṣetrajñānām adhiṣṭhānāṃ | samudra ivodakaujasām bhāvānāṃ
K Ladd atha khalv avarma sa suśruta Lkāriṇam | N°mo kṣaṇlakṣaṇam Lom Naṣṭarūm A₁₉₃₁, Lakhilasya Nakhilasyacsya Hsa|| ||cmbha° Lsaṃbhavihectur A₁₉₃₁avyaktaṃ nāma | Lavyaktan nāma | A₁₉₃₁bahūnāṃ A₁₉₃₁, N, Ladhiṣṭhānaṃadhiṣṭhānaṃ |adhiṣṭhānam Nivāda° A₁₉₃₁, Livaudakānāṃivaudackānām Nbhāvānān
1931 ed. 3.1.4 tasmād avyaktān mahān utpadyate talliṅga eva | talliṅgāc ca mahatas tallakṣaṇa evāhaṅkāra utpadyate | sa trividho vaikārikas taijaso bhūtādir iti | tatra vaikārikād ahaṃkārāt tallakṣaṇāny evaikādaśendriyāṇy utpadyante || tadyathā || śrotraṃ tvak cakṣur jjihvā ghrāṇo vāg ghastopasthapāyupādamanānsīti | tatra pūrvvāṇi pañca vuddhīndriyāṇi | itarāṇi pañca karmmendriyāṇi | ubhayātmakam manaḥ | bhūtādes tallakṣaṇāny eva pañcatanmātrāṇy utpadyante || tadyathā || śabdatanmātraṃ | sparśatanmātraṃ | rūpatanmātraṃ | rasatanmātraṃ | gandhatanmātram iti | tebhyo bhūtāni vyomānilānalajalor vvyastebhyas tadviśeṣāḥ śabdasparśarūparasagandhāḥ | evam etāni caturvviṃśati tatvāni vyākhyātāni bhavanti |
K Navyaktāmma° Letal liṃgāc Lcaṃ Nmatastalla° Ntrividhau A₁₉₃₁, Lvaikārikastaijaso Nvaikārikastejaso A₁₉₃₁°kādahaṅkārāttaijasasahāyāt A₁₉₃₁enaikā° Levaikādeśen° A₁₉₃₁, N, Ltad yathātad yathā ---tathyad yathā | A₁₉₃₁śrotratvakcakṣurjihvāghrāṇavāgghastopasthapāyupādamanāṃsīti, Nśrotratvakcackṣujihvāghrāṇovāgmastopasthapāyupādamanāṃsīti | Lśrotratvacakṣujihvāghrāṇavāghghastopasthapāyupādamanāṃsi A₁₉₃₁, Lbuddhīn°buddhīn° Lkarmmondri° A₁₉₃₁add api taijasasahāyāt A₁₉₃₁, N, Ltad yathātad yathā ---tad yathā ||tad yathā | Lsparśśatan° N°mā Lom A₁₉₃₁teṣāṃ A₁₉₃₁add viśeṣāṃ Lte A₁₉₃₁om Nvyomanilānalajalorvyas tebhyastadvi° Lsas A₁₉₃₁viśeṣāḥ A₁₉₃₁°gandhāḥ; tebhyo bhūtāni vyomānilānalajalorvyaḥ; A₁₉₃₁eṣā Ladd tatvāni Ncaturviṅśati A₁₉₃₁tattvacaturviṃśatir L°śatir A₁₉₃₁om °ni bhavanti | Lom
1931 ed. 3.1.5 tatra buddhīndriyāṇāṃ śabdādayo viṣayāḥ | karmmendriyāṇāṃ yathāsaṃkhyāvacanādān ānandavisarggaviharaṇāni |
K Lviṣayoḥ | Nyathāsaṃkhyavacanānānan° A₁₉₃₁yathāsaṅkhyaṃ vacanādānānan° Lyathāsaṃkhyaṃ vacanādānānandavisargavicāraṇāni |
1931 ed. 3.1.6 avyaktam mahān ahaṃkāraḥ pañcatanmātrāṇi cety aṣṭau prakṛtayaḥ śeṣāḥ ṣoḍaśavikārāḥ
K Larvavyakta A₁₉₃₁mahānahaṅ° Lmahcānahaṃkārāḥ | Nceṣṭaty A₁₉₃₁, N, Lṣoḍaśa vikārāḥṣoḍaśa vikārāḥ ||ṣoḍaśa vikārāḥ |
1931 ed. 3.1.7 svaṃ svaṃ svaiṣāṃ viṣaye vibhutvaṃ | svayam adhyātmam adhidevan tu | atha vuddher vvrahyā | ahaṃkārasyeśvaraḥ | manasaś candramāḥ | diśaḥ śrotrasya | tvaco vāyuḥ | sūryaś cakṣuṣaḥ | rasanā āpaḥ | pṛthivī ghrāṇasya | vāco 'gniḥ | hastayor indra | pādayor vviṣṇuḥ | pāyor mmitraḥ | prajāpatir upasthasyeti |
K A₁₉₃₁svaḥ Lom A₁₉₃₁svaś Nsvaṃś A₁₉₃₁, Ncaiṣāṃcaiṣā A₁₉₃₁viṣayo A₁₉₃₁'dhibhūtaṃ; Nadhyātmadhi° A₁₉₃₁adhidaivataṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁tu---budher Nbuddhe A₁₉₃₁brahyā, Nbrahmī | A₁₉₃₁, Nrasanasyāpaḥrasanasyāpaḥ,rasanasyāpaḥ | Hrasanā...paḥ | Nvācogniḥ A₁₉₃₁, Nindraḥindraḥ,indraḥ |
1931 ed. 3.1.8 tatra sarvva evācetanaḥ | eṣa varggaḥ | puruṣaś ca pañcaviṃśatitamaś cetayitā | sa tu karaṇakāryasaṃprayuktaḥ saty apy acetanye pradhānasya puruṣakaivalyārthān pravṛttim upadiśanti | kṣīrādīm̐ś cātra hetūr udāharanti ||
K Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lom Npañcaviṅśatiś L°tikañ A₁₉₃₁om Lso Lom A₁₉₃₁kāryakāraṇasaṃyuktaś Lvikāry akācraṇasaṃyuktas N°yuktāḥ | A₁₉₃₁add cetayitā bhavati | Nsatyapyācaitanye A₁₉₃₁, Lacaitanye Lpradhācne | Lpuruṣasya kaivalyārtthāṃ A₁₉₃₁°lyārthaṃ N°lyārthām Npravṛttam A₁₉₃₁, Nkṣīrādīṃś Lkṣīrādīñ A₁₉₃₁, Lhetūn Nhenudā°
1931 ed. 3.1.9 ata ūrdhvam prakṛtipuruṣayoḥ sādharmmyavaidharmmye vyākhyāsyāmaḥ || ubhāv apy anādī ubhāv apy anantau | ubhāv apy anityau | ubhāv apy aparau ubhāv apy aliṅgau ubhau ca sarvvagatāv iti || ekā tu prakṛtir acetanā triguṇā vījadharmmiṇī prasavadharmminī madhyadharmmiṇī ceti | vahavas tu puruṣāś cetanāv antaḥ | aguṇā avījadharmmiṇo prasavadharmmiṇo madhyasthadharmmiṇaś ceti |
K A₁₉₃₁vyākhyāsyāmaḥ | tadyathā --- Ladd tadyathā | Nubhāvapyanādī Lom Namyanantau | Lanādī | A₁₉₃₁, Laliṅgaualiṅgau,aLliṃgau | A₁₉₃₁nityau, Lanantau | A₁₉₃₁anaparau, Naliṅge | Lnityau | N°nātiguṇā A₁₉₃₁bīja° Lbījadharmaṇī | A₁₉₃₁°rmiṇy N°rmiṇī Lamaddhyasthadharmmaṇī A₁₉₃₁, Namadhyasthadha° A₁₉₃₁, Lbahavas Npuruṣā A₁₉₃₁cetanāvanto N, Lcetanāvantaḥ | A₁₉₃₁'guṇā A₁₉₃₁abījadharmāṇo Labījadharmmiṇīḥ | Nabījadharmiṇo Lapra° A₁₉₃₁°dharmāṇo Lmaddhyasthāś A₁₉₃₁°dharmāṇaś
1931 ed. 3.1.10 tatra kāraṇānurūpaṃ kāryam iti kṛtvā sarvva evaite ca viśeṣāḥ | satvarajastamomayā bhavanti | tad añcanatvāt tanmayatvāc ca tadguṇe eva puruṣo bhavatīty eke bhāṣante
K A₁₉₃₁, N, Lom Nviśoṣāḥ | Lbhavantī | Ltadvyañjana° A₁₉₃₁, Ntadañjana° Ladd taj Ljanmatvāc A₁₉₃₁tadguṇā Ntadguṇa Ltatguṇā A₁₉₃₁, Lpuruṣā A₁₉₃₁, Lbhavantītybhacvantī|ty Nbhavatītyeke
1931 ed. 3.1.11 vaidyake tu || svabhāvo niyatiḥ kālaḥ pariṇāmastatheś caraḥ |
yadṛcchati ca manyante prakṛtim pṛthudarśiṇaḥ ||
K N, Lvaidikevaitadike A₁₉₃₁, Lsvabhāvamsvacbhāvaṃ A₁₉₃₁īśvaraṃ Līśvaraḥ A₁₉₃₁kālaṃ A₁₉₃₁add yaddacchāṃ Ladd yadracchā A₁₉₃₁niyatiṃ tathā || Lniyatis tathā | N°statheśvaraḥ | A₁₉₃₁pariṇāmaṃ Lpariṇāṃ A₁₉₃₁om Nyadṛccheti Liti Lprāhuḥ Lom A₁₉₃₁, N, L°rśinaḥ°rśinaḥ ||°rśinacḥ |°rśinaḥ |
1931 ed. 3.1.12 tato jātāni bhūtāni tadguṇāny eva nirddiśet |
tebhyas tallakṣaṇaḥ kṛtsno bhūtagrāmaḥ prajāyate ||
K A₁₉₃₁tanmayāny Ltamomayāni A₁₉₃₁add eva Ltat_Lguṇāny A₁₉₃₁cādiśet || Llakṣayet | A₁₉₃₁, Ltaiś A₁₉₃₁, Ladd ca Ntallakṣaṇoḥ Ltallakṣaṇāḥ | Lkṛsnā Lbhūtagrāmāḥ Nbhūgrām apra° A₁₉₃₁vyajanyata || Lprajajñire |
1931 ed. 3.1.13 tasyopayogo bhihitaś cikitsām prati sarvvadā |
bhūtebhyo pi paran tasmān nāsti cintā cikitsite ||
K N°yogobhi hitañ Ncikitsāmprati c Nbhūtebhyoṣiparet A₁₉₃₁, Lhi A₁₉₃₁paraṃ Lparā Ladd cintā A₁₉₃₁yasmān Lyasmāt_ Lom
1931 ed. 3.1.14 yato 'bhihitaṃ tat sambhavadravyasamūho bhūtādir ukta iti | bhautikāni cendriyāṇy āyurvvede varṇṇyante tathaivendriyārthāḥ ||
K Nbhihitan Lhitan Lom A₁₉₃₁uktaḥ; Liti c imāni Lāyurvecdadvido ubadanti | A₁₉₃₁tathendriyārthaḥ || Ltathā | indriyārtthāṃś N°yārthaḥ || Ladd ca |
1931 ed. 3.1.15 bhavati cātra || indriyair indriyārthaṃ tu svaṃ svaṃ gṛhṇāti mānavaḥ |
niyataṃ tulyayonitvān nāmyenānyam iti sthitiḥ ||
K Lbhak | A₁₉₃₁indriyeṇendiyārthaṃ Lindriyeṇendiyartthaṃ Niyandriyārthan N, Lniyatan A₁₉₃₁°nitvānnānyenānyam N, Lnānyenānyamnānyenānyacm
1931 ed. 3.1.16 na cāyurvvedaśāstreṣūpadiśyante || sarvvagatākṣetrajñanityāś ca asarvvagateṣu ca kṣetrajñeṣv anityeṣu ca puruṣākhyāpakān hetūn udāharanti | āyurvvedasiddhāntād asarvvagatā kṣetrajñā nityāś ca | tiryagyonimānuṣadeveṣu ca sañcaranti | dharmmādharmmanimittaṃ tu etenumānagrāhyāś carāḥ paramaśūkṣmāś cetanāvantaḥ śāśvatāḥ śukrārttavayoḥ sannipāteṣv abhivyajyante | yato 'bhihitam yañ ca mahābhūtaḥ śarīrasamavāyaḥ puruṣa iti | sa khalv eṣa karmmapuruṣaś cikitsāyām adhikṛtaḥ |
K A₁₉₃₁, Lsarvagatāḥ kṣetrajñā nityāśsarvagatāḥ kṣetrajñāḥ nityāś N°trajñā nityāś Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lkṣetrajñeṣu A₁₉₃₁nityapuruṣakhyā° Lom Npuruṣakhyāpakāṃ Lpuruṣasaṃkhyātiprakārān Ntudā° L°rantī | A₁₉₃₁°daśāstrasiddhānteṣv L°tāḥ A₁₉₃₁°gatāḥ Nkṣetrajñā'n ity āś Lanityāś A₁₉₃₁, Lom N°mittan A₁₉₃₁, Ntata Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lete nu°ete 'nu° Nete numān agrāhyāś A₁₉₃₁, Lom Lparamasūkṣmāś A₁₉₃₁paramasūkṣmāśceta° Ncetati nā° A₁₉₃₁śāśvatā Lca A₁₉₃₁lohitaretasoḥ Lśoṇitanetasāṃ Nadd sa Lsannipcādeṣu Labhivyañjyante | Npañcama° Lpañcamachābhūtaśa° A₁₉₃₁pañcamahābhūtaśarīrisa° Nśarīrisa° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁eṣa(eva?) Nkarmapuruṣaci° A₁₉₃₁cikitsādhikṛtaḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.1.17 tasya khalu sukhaduḥkhecchādveṣaprayatnaḥ prāṇāpānau vuddhir mmanaḥ saṃkalpo vicāraṇānusmṛtijñānam adhyavasāyo viṣayopalabdhiś ca guṇāḥ |
K A₁₉₃₁, Lom Lsukhaduḥkham icchādveṣau pra° A₁₉₃₁sukhaduḥkhe icchādveṣau pra° N°prapanna A₁₉₃₁, Ladd unmeṣanimeṣau Nadd nimeṣonmeṣau A₁₉₃₁, Lbuddhir A₁₉₃₁, L°ṇā smṛtir vijñānam°ṇā | smṛtir vijñānam_ Lom Ladd tu dha
1931 ed. 3.1.18 sātvikās tu ānṛśaṃsyaṃ samvibhāgarucitā titikṣā satyan dharmma āstikyaṃ jñānaṃ vuddhir mmedhā smṛtir anabhiṣvaṅgatā ca || rājasās tu duḥkhavahulatāghradānaṃ duḥśīlatvam akāruṇyam ānṛtikatvam ahaṃkāro dambho māno harṣaḥ kāmakrodhaś ceti || tāmasās tu viṣāditvaṃ nāstikyam adharmmaśīlatā vuddhinirodho 'jñānaṃ durmmedhastvam akarmmaśīlatā nidrālutvañ ceti ||
K A₁₉₃₁, Lsaṃvibhā° N°tātikṣāsatyaṃ A₁₉₃₁satyaṃ Lsatyadharmāv Ladd vijñānaṃ A₁₉₃₁, Lbuddhir Lmme Ndhṛtir Ldhṛti A₁₉₃₁add dhṛtir A₁₉₃₁anabhiṣaṅgaś Nanabhicṭhaṅga Lnabhiṣagaś Lceti N°tā pradānaṃ Lduḥkhabahulatāṭanataraduśśīlatvam A₁₉₃₁duḥkhabahulatā'ṭanaśīlatā 'dhṛtirahaṅkāra A₁₉₃₁akāruṇyaṃ Nahaṃkaro Lsam_bhamānacharṣa A₁₉₃₁krodhaś Lkrodha kāmāś Ladd ca A₁₉₃₁ca; Lbhavanti | Nmasās Nviśādinvan Ldharmmaśīlatat Lbuddhi° A₁₉₃₁buddher nidho N°rodhojñānaṃ Ljñānan Ldurmmedhatvam
1931 ed. 3.1.19 antarikṣās tu śabdaśabdendriyaṃ sarvvacchidrasamūho viviktatā ca | vāyavyās tu sparśaḥ sparśendriyaṃ sarvvaceṣṭāsamūhaḥ sarvvaśarīspandaranaṃ laghutā ca | taijasās tu rūpaṃ rūpendriyaṃ varṇṇasantāpo bhrājiṣṇutā paktir amarṣas taikṣṇyañ ca | āpyās tu raso ca rasendriyaṃ sarvvadravasamūho gurutā śaityaṃ sneho retaś ca | pārthivās tu gandho gandhendriyaṃ sarvvamūrttisamūho gurutā ca |
K Lāntarikṣāstu A₁₉₃₁āntarikṣāstu---śabdaḥ śa° Lśacbdaś śa° Nśabdaḥ sarvendriyaṃ Lsarvajidrasamūhe ra Lsparśa A₁₉₃₁sparśondriyaṃ Nsparśendriyacsa° A₁₉₃₁, L°rīraspandanaṃ°rīraspandanam N°rīraspandanalaghutā Ntejasās Ladd sa A₁₉₃₁, Nvarṇaḥ san°varṇṇaḥ san° Lvarṇasamūho Ldrāji° Nbhrājiṣṭutāpaktir Namarṣak Nadd tat Ntaikṣṇyañ A₁₉₃₁add śauryaṃ Ladd pīvyañ A₁₉₃₁, Lraso Nrasāra° A₁₉₃₁, Lrasanendriyaṃrasanendriyam_ Lom Nsarvamūrrtisa° A₁₉₃₁sarvamūrtasa° A₁₉₃₁, Lceticeti ||ceti |
1931 ed. 3.1.20 tatra satvavahulam ākāśaṃ | rajovahulo vāyuḥ | satvarajovahulo 'gniḥ | satvatamovahula āpaḥ | tamovahulā pṛthivī ||
K A₁₉₃₁, Lsattvabahulamsatvabahulam Nākāśāṃ | A₁₉₃₁, Lrajobahulorajobahulo A₁₉₃₁°jobahulo L°cjobahulāgniḥ N°huclogniḥ | A₁₉₃₁, L°mobahulā N°hulo A₁₉₃₁, Ltamobahulā Lpṛthiviti | A₁₉₃₁add ti ||
1931 ed. 3.1.21 bhavati cātra ||
anyonyāni praviṣṭāni sarvvāṇy etāni nirddiśet |
sve sve dravyeṣu sarvveṣāṃ vyaktalakṣaṇam iṣyate ||
K A₁₉₃₁ślokau Nbha || A₁₉₃₁, Lcātra Hcātra || A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁bhavataḥ | Lślclokaḥ | A₁₉₃₁, Lom
1931 ed. 3.1.22 aṣṭau prakṛtayaḥ proktā vikārāś caiva ṣoḍaśa |
kṣetrajñāś ca samāsena svatantraparatantrata iti ||
K Nprakṛtaya Lprakṛtiya Lproktaḥ A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁ṣoḍaśaiva tu || Nṣoḍaśaḥ | LṣoḍaLśaiva Ladd tu | A₁₉₃₁, N, Lkṣetrajñaśkṣectrajñaśkṣetrajñas Ltu Nsutantra pa° Lparatantrasvatantrataḥ || A₁₉₃₁°trayoḥ||

śārīrasya prathamo 'dhyāyaḥ ||

[Adhyāya 2: draft based on MS H and N (up to 35) (June 2024)]

1931 ed. 3.2.1 athātaḥ śukraśoṇitaviśuddhiṃ śārīraṃ vyākhyāsyāmaḥ ||*
K Lsuśrutaḥ | A₁₉₃₁°taśuddhiṃ Lom Nom
    • Witness N omits śārīraṃ, which offers a clearer syntax. Note that the 1931 and 1938 editions of the vulgate text offer two different solutions to the awkward phrase.
K A₁₉₃₁add yathovāca bhagavān dhanvantariḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.2.3 vāta pitta śleṣma* śoṇita kuṇapa granthi pūti pūya kṣīṇa mūtra purīṣa retāṃsi prajotpādaneṣv asamarthāni bhavanti |
K Le Lom Lom A₁₉₃₁retasaḥ A₁₉₃₁°ne A₁₉₃₁na samarthā Lasamanyāni Naśagarthā
    • The 1931 and 1938 editions of the SS by Ācārya have different readings at this point. śonita is included in the 1931 edition but omitted in the 1938 edition. There also seems to be some textual confusion between granthi and gandhi in the next passage.
1931 ed. 3.2.4 teṣu vātavarṇṇavedanaṃ vātena | pittavarṇṇavedanaṃ pittena | śleṣmavarṇṇavedanaṃ śleṣmaṇā | śoṇitavarṇṇam pittavedanaṃ śoṇitena | kuṇapañ ca raktena | granthibhūtaṃ śleṣmavātābhyāṃ | pūtipūyanibhaṃ pittaśoṇitābhyāṃ | kṣīṇaśukraṃ pittamārutābhyāṃ | mūtrapurīṣagandhi sannipātena | teṣu kuṇapa granthi pūti pūya retasaḥ kṛcchrasādhyāḥ | mūtrapurīṣaretasas tv asādhyā iti |
K Nom N, Lom N tena | Lom N°danām Ldoṣanimittāni Npattena | Lsvarṇavedanābhicr N°danaśleṣmaṇā | Lom N°varṇṇa A₁₉₃₁°varṇavedanaṃ Lvijñeyāni | A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁, Lkuṇapagandhyanalpaṃkuṇapagandhyanalpam_ Lom Lpūtipūyācbham_ A₁₉₃₁pittaśleṣmabhyāṃ, A₁₉₃₁kṣīṇaṃ prāg uktaṃ Lkṣīṇaṃ Nkṣīṇaśukrapi° Lprāg Nmūtrāpu° Luktacm_ puriṣa° A₁₉₃₁, L°teneti | Nkulaṇaṇapa Lgandhi Lom Npūraya A₁₉₃₁add kṣīṇa Lretāṃsi A₁₉₃₁°dhyāh, L°ddhyāni Lpuriṣaretas Nom °sas… | A₁₉₃₁asādhyāḥ iti || Lasāddhyam iti |
1931 ed. 3.2.5 ārttavam api tribhir ddoṣaiḥ śoṇitacaturthaih pṛthak dvandvais tribhiḥ samastaiś copasṛṣṭam abījan bhavati | tad api doṣavarṇṇavedanābhir vvijñeyaṃ | teṣu kuṇapagranthi pūtipūya prakāśan tad asādhyaṃ sādhyam anyac ceti ||
K Nom Nom Liti Nbhir N, L°turthaiḥ°turtthair Lom A₁₉₃₁pṛthagdvandvaiḥ Npṛthakdvandvais A₁₉₃₁, Lom Lcopasṛṣṭabījam_ A₁₉₃₁, Nabījaṃabījam Ljam Hadd na A₁₉₃₁°nādibhir N°nāticbhir L°grandhi Lpūya A₁₉₃₁add kṣīṇamūtrapurīṣa A₁₉₃₁, Lprakāśamprakāśamprakāśaṃ A₁₉₃₁, Lom Lkṛcchrasāddhyaṃ Ladd puriṣārttavam Lacsāddhyaṃ Nanyac ceti || Lom
1931 ed. 3.2.6 bhavati cātra ||
teṣv ādyāñ śukradoṣāṃs trīn snehasvedādibhir jjayet |
kriyāviśeṣair mmatimān tathaivottaravastibhiḥ ||
K A₁₉₃₁, Nbhavanti Lbha | A₁₉₃₁ādyān Nādyāṃ Hādyāḥ Lcchukra° Hśuckradoṣās N, Htrī Ltrīṃ Lsnehanasve° A₁₉₃₁tathā cottarabastibhiḥ ||
6.1 tatra vātātmake retasi bilvavidārīkṣīram āsthāpanam | madhūka rāsnā devadāru sarala vipakvan tailan tad uttaravastiṣu vidadhyāt || dāḍima mātuluṅga phala saindhava kṣāra vasukavasira siddhaṃ sarppiḥ pāyayet ||
K A₁₉₃₁, Lom Ntailam Nom Hmātulaṅga
3.2.6.2 pittātmake retasi payasyāśrīparṇṇīmadhukavipakvaṃ kṣīram āsthāpanaṃ | sarjjadhavakalkaṃ yonyā dhārayet | madhukavipakvaṃ tailam anuvāsanaṃ | tad evottaravastiñ ca vidadhyāt | kāṇḍekṣu śvadaṃṣtrā guḍūcī madhuparṇṇī bhṛṅga pañcamūla siddhaṃ sarppiḥ pāyayet ||
K Npiḍrātmaka A₁₉₃₁, Lom N°parkaṃ Nom N°parkatailam Nkaṇṭhekṣu Nśvadaṃṣṭrā N, Hbhṛṇa N°lale Npayet ||
3.2.6.3 śleṣmātmake retasi rājavṛkṣakaṣāyam āsthāpanaṃ | pippalīviḍaṃgamadhuvipakvan tailam anuvāsanan | tad evottaravastiñ ca vidadhyāt | pāṣaṇabheda kāśmaryāmalaka pippalī vasuka vasira siddhaṃ ghṛtam prayacchet pānārthaṃ ||
K A₁₉₃₁, Lom N°parkan N°na Hpāṣāṇa° Npāṣāṇabhedaka Nkāśmama° Npippaltī
1931 ed. 3.2.7 bhavanti cātra ślokāḥ ||
pāyayen manujaṃ sarpir bhiṣak śoṇita retasi |
dhātakīpuṣpakhadira dāḍimārjjuna sādhitam ||
K Nom A₁₉₃₁om Lom Nśloka || A₁₉₃₁pāyayeta naraṃ Nmacnujan Hbhbhiṣa° A₁₉₃₁bhiṣak kuṇapa Nbhiṣaj choṇita Ndāḍimārjjana
1931 ed. 3.2.8 kuṇapākhye pibet sarppiḥ śālasārādisādhitaṃ ||
granthibhūte 'śmabhiḥ siddhaṃ pālāśe cāpi bhasmani ||
K A₁₉₃₁pāyayed Nkuṇapākhyo A₁₉₃₁athavā Lcla° Nsmabhi A₁₉₃₁śaṭīsaiddhaṃ Lcpālāśair A₁₉₃₁, Lvāpivā'pi Hcā pic Lbhasmabhiḥ |
1931 ed. 3.2.9 parūṣakavaṭādibhyām pūyābhe cāpi sādhitam ||
prāguktaṃ vakṣyate yac ca tat kāryaṃ kṣīṇaretasi ||
K N°kaṭāṭādibhyām Lom A₁₉₃₁pūyaprakhye A₁₉₃₁ca Ntatñāyaṃ
1931 ed. 3.2.10 viṭprabhe pāyayet sarppiś citrakośīrahiṅgubhiḥ |*
K Lom A₁₉₃₁siddhaṃ
    • The vulgate and Nepalese texts diverge again this point. The vulgate adds a half-śloka snigdhaṃ vāntaṃ ... that is not present in the Nepalese version. The Nepalese version then has about eleven passages that are absent in the vulgate. The vulgate's verses 3.2.11cd and 3.2.12ab then appear as a single verse after 3.2.32.
K, N, H A₁₉₃₁add snigdhaṃ vāntaṃ viriktaṃ ca nirūḍham anuvāsitam ||
3.2.10.1 snehādīnāṃ kramaṃ kuryāt ṣaṭsv eteṣu paṇḍitaḥ ||*
A₁₉₃₁, K Lsnehādiś Ladd ca Lkamaḥ Nkuct Lkāryyaḥa Nṣaṭkhapy Lpañcasv Neḍeṣu Hateṣu Ljānatā |
    • Although not printed in the vulgate editions, the editor Y. T. Ācārya noted that words to this effect were present in some sources (1931 ed., p. 290, note 2; 1938 ed., p. 345, note 3).
3.2.10.2 asevanāc ciraṃ strīṇāṃ kriyāyogāt tathaiva ca |
kaṣāyakaṭutiktānāṃ dravyāṇām atisevanāt ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, L Nasevaṇāc Hdrvyāṇām
3.2.10.3 tathāmlaṃ lavaṇaṃ rūkṣaṃ śuktaṃ paryuṣitan tathā |
vegāghātāc ca yonīnāṃ gamanāc ca praduṣyati ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, L Htathāslaṃla° Ntathāmblala° Npayuṣitan Hvegād yātāc Hyogīnāṃ
3.2.10.4 tathārttavadoṣe ca snehādikarmam upadiśet |
yathaivoktan tathaivottaravastiñ ca vidadhyāt |
A₁₉₃₁, K, L Ntathāva° N°karma sa Npadaset |
3.2.10.5 tatrāśaṇavātātmake bhaṅgābhadradārukāśmaryaphalasiddhaṃ ghṛtam pāyayet |
payasyā kāśmarya phala kṣīra vidārī kṣīrodaka siddhaṃ vā kṛsarapāyasapiṇḍaṃ yonyān dhārayet |
A₁₉₃₁, K, L Ntatra vā° N°kāśyapaphalasindhaghṛtaṃ Nthārya NkṣīrodaL... Nom Nom Nom kṛsara° Nyonyāṃ Nkṣāra>yet |
3.2.10.6 madhukamuṅgaparṇṇīkaṣāyam ācamanaṃ pittātmake cārttave |
A₁₉₃₁, K, L
3.2.10.7 kākolīkṣīravidārīkvāthaṃ śarkkarāyuktam pāyayet | madhūkapuṣpakāśmaryaphalakvātham phānitayuktam vā candanapayasyākalkaṃ yonyān dhārayet | nimbagairikakaṣāyam ācamanaṃ || śleṣmātmake bhadraśriyakaṭukarohiṇīkaṣāyam pāyayet | kṣīravṛkṣapravālakalkam vā | tindukakapithaśalāṭucūrṇṇam vā kṣaudreṇa lehayet | sarjjadhavakalkaṃ yonyān dhārayet | lodhratindukakaṣāyam ācamanaṃ ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, L N°rītkāthaṃ Hmadhuka° Nphāṇita° Nom Nom Npāyayet || Nnigvarauri° Nacimanaṃ | N°ṣā Nyayet | N°lāducūrṇṇam Nsarjathacva° Nyonyām Nvārayet || Hlādhra° N°dukaṣāyam
3.2.10.8 granthibhūte śṛṅgaverapāṭhācūrṇṇayuktaṃ śvetasurasām prayacchet | kuṣṭhabhadradārukalkaṃ yonyān dhārayet | teṣām eva kaṣāyam ācamanaṃ ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, L N°yuktāṃ Nprayacchetuā Hyonyāndhā° Nyonyāmvāra°
3.2.10.9 kuṇapākhye mañjiṣṭhābhadraśriyakaṣāyaṃ pāyayet || kuṭajaphalabhadraśriyacandanam vā śarkkarāyuktaṃ || pūyābhe vā tad eva prayacchet |
A₁₉₃₁, K, L Nmaṃjiṣṭhāśraya° Nkuṭujaphalabhadrapriya° Npūyābhevātadecva
3.2.10.10 khadirārjjunakalkaṃ yonyāṃ hārayet | tayor eva kaṣāyam ācamanaṃ || krimijāte vidañgapāribhadrakamañjiṣṭhākaṣāyam pāyayet |
A₁₉₃₁, K, L Nvārayet | Nviḍaṅga°
3.2.10.11 kṣaudrayuktaṃ surāṣṭāṣṭrārocanākalkam bhadraśriyakalkaṃ yonyān dhāryet | tayor eva kaṣāyam ācamanam bhavati ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, L Nsurāṣṭhāro° N°kalkayuktaṃ Nyonyām Nvārayet || Nta...va Nom
1931 ed. 3.2.12cd bhavati cātra ||
vidhim uttaravastyantaṃ kuryād ārtavaśuddhaye |
K A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁uttarabastyantaṃ L°vastyuktaṃ
K, N, H, L A₁₉₃₁add strīṇāṃ snehādiyuktānāṃ catasṛṣv ārtavārtiṣu ||
1931 ed. 3.2.13cd kuryāt kalkam picūṃś cāpi pathyāny ācamanāni ca ||
K A₁₉₃₁kalkān Lkalpān Npi Npathyācma°
1931 ed. 3.2.14cd durggandhapūtisaṃkāśe majjābhe vāpi śoṇite |
K, N Ldurgandhe pū° A₁₉₃₁durgandhipūyasaṅ° A₁₉₃₁majjatulye Lmajjobhe A₁₉₃₁tathā Lc A₁₉₃₁'rtave ||
1931 ed. 3.2.15 pibed bhadraśriyakvāthañ candanakvātham eva vā ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L
1931 ed. 3.2.14ab granthibhūte pibet pāṭhāṃ tryūṣaṇaṃ vṛkṣakāṇi ca |
K Lcṭhā Npāṭhābhyūcṣaṇāvṛkṣakāni Lvṛkṣakaṃ Lkaṭubhis Ltribhiḥ |
3.2.14.1 kṣāranāgarahiṃgūnān niḥkvāthaṃ surasām pibet ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, H, L
K A₁₉₃₁add yogānāṃ śuddhikaraṇaṃ śeṣāsv apy ārtavārtiṣu || anne(nnaṃ) śāliyavaṃ madyaṃ hitaṃ māṃsaṃ ca pittalam ||
1931 ed. 3.2.24 evam aduṣṭaśukraḥ śuddhārtavā || *
K Lduṣṭaśukaś N, H, Lśuddhārttavāmśuddhārtavām ||śucddhārttavām A₁₉₃₁add ca ||
    • We emend against all the manuscript witnesses. MS H adds a Newa comma after ṛtau in the next section, suggesting that the scribe thought that was the start of a new section of text.
1931 ed. 3.2.25 ṛtau prathama divasāt prabhṛti brahmacāriṇī snānānulepanālaṅkāra vilekhana virahitā divāsvapnāñjanāśru pātābhyaṅga nakha cchedana pradhāvana hasana kathanātiśabda śravaṇāyāsam pariharet |
kiṃ kāraṇaṃ | divā svapatyā badhiraḥ | añjanād andhaḥ | rodanād vikṛtadṛṣṭiḥ | snānānulepanād duḥśīlaḥ | tailābhyaṅgāt kuṣṭhī | nakhāvakarttanāt kunakhaḥ | pralepanāt khalatiḥ | mārutāyāsasevanād unmatto garbhbho bhavatīty evam etān* pariharet ||
darbha saṃstaraṇa śāyinīṃ karatala śarāva parṇṇānām anyatama bhojinīṃ haviṣyaṃ tryahaṃ bharttā rakṣet | tataḥ śuddhasnātān tu caturthyām anāhata vastravāsinīm alaṅkṛtāṃ kṛtamaṅgalasvasti vācanām bharttāran darśayed |
api tat kasya hetoḥ ||
K N...thama H, L°riṇīṃ°riṇīm_ Nsnānanu° L°kārācvalekhana A₁₉₃₁om H°tān Lom N°nācśrū A₁₉₃₁pāta snānānulepanābhyaṅga A₁₉₃₁śravaṇāvalekhanānilāyāsān H°yāsām A₁₉₃₁svapantyāḥ Nsvapantyā A₁₉₃₁svāpaśīlaḥ, Hom Najerād Hom Hom Hom A₁₉₃₁°nā A₁₉₃₁duḥkhaśīlaḥ, Hadd vadhiraḥ | añjanād andhaḥ | rodanād N°gā A₁₉₃₁nakhāpaka° A₁₉₃₁kunakhī pradhāvanāc cañcalaḥ, A₁₉₃₁add hasanāc chyāvadantauṣṭhatālujihvāḥ, A₁₉₃₁pralāpī cātikathanāt, Npralekhanā Lom A₁₉₃₁add atiśabdaśravaṇād badhiraḥ, avalekhanāt Nlati || Lrahitāṃ Nmārutoṣase° Lom Hutmatto A₁₉₃₁, Ngarbho N, Hetām Lom Hdarbhbha A₁₉₃₁, Lsaṃstara Nsaṃstaraṃ Nśārpi Lśāyinim c Nsarovapa° Lparṇāvyannya° A₁₉₃₁parṇānya° Lbhojinim c A₁₉₃₁haniṣyaṃ, Nhaviṣyan Lbhaviṣya A₁₉₃₁add ca A₁₉₃₁bhartuḥ A₁₉₃₁saṃra° Lraṣite | A₁₉₃₁śuddhasnātāṃ Lśuddhasnātācñ A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁caturthe A₁₉₃₁'hany ahata Lhata A₁₉₃₁vāsāṃ Lvāsinam | A₁₉₃₁samalaṅ° N°galaṃ svasti Lvācakāṃ A₁₉₃₁bhartāraṃ Nbhartur A₁₉₃₁om
    • We emend from etām to the vulgate's etān for sense.
1931 ed. 3.2.26 bhavati cātra ||
pūrvvam paśyed ṛtusnātā yādṛśan naram aṅganā |
tādṛśañ janayet putram bharttāran darśayet tataḥ ||
K A₁₉₃₁, H, Lom A₁₉₃₁yādṛśaṃ Nsan Na...nā | Ltadṛśañ A₁₉₃₁bhartāraṃ A₁₉₃₁, Lataḥataḥ ||ataḥ |
1931 ed. 3.2.27 tato vidheyaṃ putrīyam upādhyāyaḥ samācaret |
karmānte ca kramaṃ hy etam avekṣyeta vicakṣaṇaḥ ||
K A₁₉₃₁, Lvidhānaṃ Nvidheya A₁₉₃₁purtīyam Nṣuṃtrīyam Lputriyam Lsamārabhet | Nkarmāt te Lkarmante Nkraṃcma Lom A₁₉₃₁enam Lcedam A₁₉₃₁ārabheta Lupeckṣeta
1931 ed. 3.2.28 tato 'parāhṇe pumān sarppiḥkṣīrābhyāṃ śālyodanam abhiprāśya māsaṃ brahmacārī tailamāṣottāhārān nārīm upagacched rātrau sāmabhir abhiviśvāsya vikalpyam evaṃ caturthyāṃ ṣāṣṭhyām aṣṭamyān daśamyāṃ dvādaśyāñ copeyād |*
K Ladd ca Nṣumāṃ A₁₉₃₁add māsaṃ brahmacārī sarpiḥsnigdhaḥ Lsarppikṣī° A₁₉₃₁bhuktvā Nabhiprāśyam Nāsam A₁₉₃₁brahmacāriṇīṃ tailasnigdhāṃ A₁₉₃₁°ṣottarāhārāṃ N, H°ṣottarāhārān°ṣottarāhācrān L°cṣottarān A₁₉₃₁, Lupeyādupeyāt | A₁₉₃₁sāmādibhir Lviśvāsyā | Hvikalpam Lsaṃkalpya A₁₉₃₁vikalpyaivaṃ Lca Levam A₁₉₃₁, N, Lṣaṣṭhyāmṣaṣṭhyām A₁₉₃₁aṣṭamyāṃ Npayād Nom Nataḥ Lvopeyāt | A₁₉₃₁add iti putrakāmaḥ ||
    • Witness N inserts a misplaced folio at this point, image A 1267_11_67.jpg, covering SS.3.2.22bis, 23, 33, 34, 35, 30.
K A₁₉₃₁add eṣūttarottaraṃ vidyād āyur ārogyam eva ca || prajāsaubhāgyam aiśvaryaṃ balaṃ ca divaseṣu vai ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁add ataḥ paraṃ pañcamyāṃ saptamyāṃ navamyām ekādaśyāṃ ca strīkāmaḥ; trayodaśīprabhṛtayo nindyāḥ ||
K, N, H, L A₁₉₃₁add tatra prathame divase ṛtumatyāṃ maithunagama(nama?)nāyuṣyaṃ puṃsāṃ bhavati, yaś ca tatrādhīyate garbhaḥ sa prasavamāno vimucyate; dvitīye 'py evaṃ sūtikāgṛhe vā; tṛtīye 'py evam asaṃpūrṇāṅgo 'lpāyur vā bhavati; caturthe tu saṃpūrṇāṅgo dīrghāyuś ca bhavati | na ca pravartamāne rakte bījaṃ praviṣṭaṃ guṇakaraṃ bhavati, yathā nadyāṃ pratisrotaḥ plāvidravyaṃ prakṣiptaṃ pratinivartate nordhnaṃ gacchati tadvad eva draṣṭavyam | tasmān niyamavatīṃ trirātraṃ pariharet |
1931 ed. 3.2.31.1 ataḥ paraṃ* māsād upeyāl |
K Nom Lpara Lmāsan A₁₉₃₁upeyāt || Lnopeyāt ||
    • Witness H makes a saut du même au même from ataḥ paraṃ at the start of 30 to the end of 31.
1931 ed. 3.2.32 labdhagarbhā* teṣv evāhaḥsu lakṣmaṇā vaṭa śuṅgā sahadevā viśva devānām anyatamam abhiṣūyāt | trīṃś caturo vā bindūn dadyād dakṣiṇe nāsāpuṭe putrakāmāyai vāme strīkāmāyai na cainan niṣṭhīved iti ||
K A₁₉₃₁, N, Llabdha garbhā Hlabdha garbha A₁₉₃₁add yāś N, Lnnaadd nnaadd nna Hadd nni va ca | A₁₉₃₁caiteṣv Nvata Lcaiveteṣv Nbhatpṛvā° A₁₉₃₁, LahaḥsuaLhassu Nsahasrā dervā Nviśvarectasaca° A₁₉₃₁kṣīreṇābhiṣutya Labhiṣuya Nbindun Ndakṣiṇa° Nrśāyevāme A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁ca tān Ncainaj Lcaivetan Njiṣṇīved A₁₉₃₁om Ladd bhātakā
    • Witness N is faint and written close to the abraded top of the folio so that superscript vowels are uncertain. Witness H has a scribal correction of the vowel i. The reading adopted here, with a feminine sentence subject, is neither the Nepalese nor the vulgate and is almost certainly unoriginal. Without further evidence it is not possible to recover the oldest reading.
1931 ed. 3.2.32a ślokāḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.2.11cd sphaṭikābhaṃ dravaṃ snigdhaṃ madhuram madhugandhi ca |
K, N A₁₉₃₁, H, Lom Lsphaṭickābhan Lsnigdhama
1931 ed. 3.2.12ab śukram icchanti kecit tu kṣaudratailasamaprabham ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁tailakṣaudranibhaṃ L°lanibhan A₁₉₃₁, Ltathāadd tathā ||add tacthā |
1931 ed. 3.2.17 śaśāsṛkpratimaṃ yat tu yad vā lākṣārasopamaṃ |
tad ārtavam praśansanti yac ca na virajyate ||
K Lśaśāsṛk_sadṛśaṃ N sāsṛkṣutimaṃyan N°pasaṃ | L°pamama | A₁₉₃₁, Lpraśaṃsanti Nprasusanti A₁₉₃₁vāso Ncādhbhyu H Lvcāpsu A₁₉₃₁virañjayet || Lvirajyati |
1931 ed. 3.2.18 tad evātiprasaṅgena pravṛttam anṛtāv api |
asṛgdaram vijānīyād raktalakṣaṇalakṣitaṃ ||
K Levati° A₁₉₃₁pranṛttamanṛtāv Npravṛttananṛtāv Lannṛtāv Hanṛtāvacpi | Nasṛgharaṃ A₁₉₃₁add ayo 'nyad Nrakṣaktalakṣathalakṣitaṃ || A₁₉₃₁°kṣaṇāt ||
1931 ed. 3.2.19 asṛgdaraṃ bhavet sarvvan sāṅgamarddan savedanaṃ |
atipravṛttau daurbbalyam bhramamūrcchā tam astṛṣā ||
K A₁₉₃₁asṛgdaro Lom A₁₉₃₁sarvaḥ Nsarvaṃ A₁₉₃₁sāṅgamardaḥ Nsāṅgamarddasa° A₁₉₃₁savedanaḥ || A₁₉₃₁tasyātivṛttau A₁₉₃₁bhramo mūrcchā N, Hbhrama mūrcchābhrama mūrcchā A₁₉₃₁, Ntamas tṛṣā || Htamastṛṣā ||
1931 ed. 3.2.20 dāhaḥ pralāpaḥ pāṇḍutvan tandrā rogāś ca vātajāḥ |
taruṇyā hitasevinyās tad alpopadravam bhavet ||
K Lom A₁₉₃₁pāṇḍutvaṃ Nhise° A₁₉₃₁tam Ntalpo° A₁₉₃₁bhiṣak ||
1931 ed. 3.2.21cd doṣair āvṛtamārggatvād ārttavan naśyati striyāḥ |
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, H, L
1931 ed. 3.2.22 tatra māṃsa kulatthāmla tilamāṣasurā hitāḥ ||
pāne mūtram udaśvic ca dadhiśuktañ ca bhojane |
K Lom A₁₉₃₁matsya Nmānsa Nkulatthāmbla Nhitā || Nreṃ Nudatsvir Nva
1931 ed. 3.2.23 kṣīṇam prāgīritaṃ raktaṃ salakṣa-ṇacikitsitaṃ ||
tathāpyasya vidhātavyam vidhānaṃ raktapittavat |
K Lom A₁₉₃₁tathā'py atra Ntathāpy asya A₁₉₃₁naṣṭaraktavat ||
1931 ed. 3.2.33 dhruvañ caturṇṇāṃ sānnidhye garbhbhaḥ syād vidhipūrvvakaḥ ||
kṣettrabījodakatṛṇāṃ sāmagryād aṅkuro yathā ||
K Ndhrūvam Ldhruvan Ltrayāṇāṃ Ncaturṇṇāsāniṇyagarbhaṃ A₁₉₃₁, Lsānnidhyādsānniddhyāt A₁₉₃₁garbhaḥ Lgarbha Hsyādvidhi° A₁₉₃₁°rvakaḥ || L°rvakam || A₁₉₃₁ṛtukṣetrāmbubījānāṃ Nkṣatrabījodakarkkunāt Lkṣetrambījodakādīrāṃ Lsānniddhyād Naṃjju
1931 ed. 3.2.34 evaṃ jātā rūpavanto mahāsattvāś cirāyuṣaḥ ||
bhavanty ṛṇapramoktāras saputrāḥ putriṇāṃ hitāḥ ||
K Nrūpavattā Lrūpāvanto A₁₉₃₁sattvavantaś Nmahāsandhāś N, Lāṇa°āṇa°āṇa° A₁₉₃₁ṛṇasya mo° A₁₉₃₁, Lsatputrāḥ A₁₉₃₁putriṇe(ṇo) Lputriṇā
1931 ed. 3.2.35 tatra tejodhātur varṇṇānām prabhavaḥ iti kṛtvā yadā garbhotpattāv apāndhātuprāyam āhāram bhavati tadā garbhbhasya gauratvaṃ |* pṛthivīdhātuprāyaḥ kṛṣṇatvaṃ | pṛthivyākāśadhātuprāyaḥ śyāmatvaṃ | yādṛkvarṇṇam āhāram upasevate garbhbhiṇī tadvarṇṇaḥ prasavo bhavtīty eke bhāṣante | yathā kṛṣṇapītaśvetāsu bhūmiṣu sarppa vṛścika galagoḍikādayaḥ satvāḥ kṛṣṇapītaśvetā iti ||* tatra dṛṣṭibhāgam apratipannan tejodhātur jjātyandhaṃ karoti | tad eva raktānugataṃ raktākṣaṃ | śleṣmānugataṃ śuklākṣaṃ | pittānugatam piṅgākṣaṃ | vātānugatam vikṛtākṣaṃ ||
K Ntejodhātuva° Ltejodhātuvarṇānāma A₁₉₃₁sarvava° A₁₉₃₁sa A₁₉₃₁om Ldayā Lcgarbhotoattāv Hapāabdhātu° A₁₉₃₁, Labdhātuprāyo A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁garbhaṃ N, Lgarbhasya A₁₉₃₁gauraṃ Lgauravaṃ A₁₉₃₁, Lkarotiadd karoti,add karoti | L°dhātuḥ cprāyaḥ A₁₉₃₁kṛṣṇaṃ, Lkāḻaba L°śatoyacdhātuḥ prāya A₁₉₃₁kṛṣṇaśyāmaṃ, toyākāśadhātuprāyo gauraśyāmam | A₁₉₃₁, Nyādṛgvarṇamyādṛgvarṇṇam Lvādṛśavarṇṇaṃ Lannacm Nupaseveta A₁₉₃₁, N, Lgarbhiṇī Ltādṛkavarṇṇaṃ A₁₉₃₁tādṛgvarṇaprasavā Lprasūta Nprajaty A₁₉₃₁bhavatīty Lity Nyadhā A₁₉₃₁, Lom N°subhūmiṣu | Hgalagoṇḍi° Nom Lpratipannas A₁₉₃₁°pannaṃ A₁₉₃₁tejo Lsa L°gato A₁₉₃₁pittānu° L°gataḥ A₁₉₃₁piṅgākṣaṃ, A₁₉₃₁śleṣmānu° L°gataḥ A₁₉₃₁śuklākṣaṃ, L°gato A₁₉₃₁add iti || Ladd iti bhakaḥ |
    • Note the slightly unusual form apān-dhātu-prāyam with the inflected genitive pl. of the first member of the compound (Whitney 1250e).
    • galagoṇḍikādayaḥ in witness H is likely to be a variant pronunciation rather than a scribal error.
3.2.35.1 bhavanti cātra ||
viśuddhaḥ pavano yasya nayane pratipadyate |
jāyete nayane tasya nimne kṛṣṇe 'site tathā* ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L Hjāyate
    • Witness H appears to read jāyate but we emend to the dual.
3.2.35.2 pittaṃ kaphayutaṃ yasya nirmmalaṃ yāti locane |
haripiṅglasamjñā vai jāyete tasya locane ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L
3.2.35.3 vinirddhūtamalaḥ śleṣmā yadā vrajati locane |
tasya netre prakāśete śuklamaṇḍalamaṇḍale ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L
3.2.35.4 raktaṅ kaphayutaṃ yasya yadā vrajati locane ||
kapotanīle nayane rakte vā jāyete nṛṇāṃ* ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L Hjāyate
    • Witness H appears to read jāyate but we emend to the dual.
1931 ed. 3.2.36 ghṛtakumbho yathā hy agnim āśritaḥ pravilīyate |
prasarpped ārttavan nāryāḥ puruṣasya samāgamāt ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add bhavanti cātra | A₁₉₃₁ghṛtapiṇḍo A₁₉₃₁yathaivāgnim A₁₉₃₁pranilī° A₁₉₃₁visarpaty A₁₉₃₁ārtavaṃ A₁₉₃₁add tathā A₁₉₃₁puṃsāṃ A₁₉₃₁samāgame ||
1931 ed. 3.2.37 bīje tu vāyunā bhinne dvau jīvau kukṣim āgatau |
yamāv ity abhidhīyete dharmmetarapurā kṛtau ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁, Lntarvāyunā'ntarvāyunāntarvāyunā L°yeta Lthacrmmetarapuraskṛtau | A₁₉₃₁°puraḥsarau ||
3.2.37.1 miśrībhāve yadā puṃso retas subahunirmmalaṃ |
tadā prasūyate nārī garbhbhiṇī dārakadvayaṃ ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L
3.2.37.2 miśrībhāve striyāś caiva bahuśukraṃ yadā bhavet |
kanyādvayan tadā nārī sūyate nātra saṃśayaḥ ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L
1931 ed. 3.2.38 āsekyo nāma bhavati strīpuṃsor alpabījayoḥ ||
sa śuklaṃ prāśya labhate dhvajocchrāyam asaṃśayaḥ ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁pitror A₁₉₃₁atyalpabījatvād āsekyaḥ A₁₉₃₁add puruṣo bhavet || A₁₉₃₁, Lśukraṃ A₁₉₃₁, Lasaṃśayamasaṃśayam ||asaṃśayuyam |
1931 ed. 3.2.39 yaḥ pūtiyonau jāyeta sa saugandhikasaṃjñitaḥ ||
sa yoniśephasor ggandham āghrāya labhate balam ||
K, N Lcpūtiyonyāñ Lyośe°
1931 ed. 3.2.40 sve gude brahmacaryād yaḥ strīṣu svāsu pravartate |
kumbhīkaḥ sa tu vijñeya īrṣyakaṃ śṛṇu cāparaṃ ||
K, N Lom H A₁₉₃₁puṃvat A₁₉₃₁ca
1931 ed. 3.2.41 dṛṣṭvā vyavāyam anyeṣāṃ vyavāyāya pravarttate |
īrṣyakaḥ sa tu vijñeyaḥ ṣaṇḍhakaṃ śṛṇu pañcamaṃ ||
K, N Lom A₁₉₃₁vyavāye yaḥ A₁₉₃₁ca A₁₉₃₁ṣaṇḍakaṃ
1931 ed. 3.2.42 kaumāryāṃ yas tv ṛtau mohād aṅganeva pravartate |
tatra strīceṣṭitākāro jāyate ṣaṇḍhasaṃjñakaḥ ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁om Lbhāryyāya Ladd sa A₁₉₃₁bhāryāyām Laṃganāvat_ A₁₉₃₁tataḥ L°tācāroḥ A₁₉₃₁, Lṣaṇḍasaṃjñitaḥṣaṇḍasaṃjñitaḥ ||ṣaṇḍasaṃjñitaḥ |
1931 ed. 3.2.43 ṛtau puruṣavac cāpi yadi yoṣit prapadyate |
tatra kanyā yadi bhavet sā bhaven naraceṣṭitā ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁vāpi A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lpravartetāṅganā yadipravartetāṅganā yadi || pravarttetāṃganā yadi |
1931 ed. 3.2.44 āsekyaś ca sugandhī ca kumbhīkaś cerṣyakas tathā |
saśukrakās tv amī jñeyā hy aśukraḥ ṣaṇḍhasaṃjñakaḥ ||
K, N Lom A₁₉₃₁saretasas A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁ṣaṇḍa(ṇḍha)saṃjñitaḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.2.45 anayor vviprakṛtyā tu teṣāṃ śukravahā sirā ||
harṣāt sphuṭatvam āyāti dhvajocchrāyan tato bhavet ||*
K, N A₁₉₃₁anayā Lom A₁₉₃₁śukravahāḥ A₁₉₃₁, Hāyāntiāyāṃti A₁₉₃₁dhvajocchrāyas
    • We emend H's reading āyānti to the singular. There are two semen-carrying vessels in the Suśrutasaṃhitā's anatomical theory (śārīrasthāna 9.12), not many.
1931 ed. 3.2.46 ākārācāracintābhir yādṛśībhiḥ samanvitau |
strīpuṃsau tu bhaveyātāṃ tayor ggarbbho 'pi tādṛśaḥ ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁āhārācāraceṣṭābhir Lom A₁₉₃₁samupeyātāṃ A₁₉₃₁putro
1931 ed. 3.2.47 yadā tu nārī nārī ca maithunāyopakalpataḥ |
muñcataḥ śukram anyonyam anasthis tatra jāyate ||
K, N Lom A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁nāryāv A₁₉₃₁upeyātāṃ A₁₉₃₁add vṛṣasyantyau A₁₉₃₁kathaṃcana || A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁muñcantyau Hmuñcantaḥ
K, N A₁₉₃₁add ṛtusnātā tu yā nārī svapne maithunam āvahet || ārtavaṃ vāyur ādāya kukṣau garbhaṃ karoti hi ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁add māsi māsi vivardheta garbhiṇyā garbhalakṣaṇam || kalalaṃ jāyate tasyā varjitaṃ paitṛkair guṇaiḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.2.50 sarppa vṛścika kuṣmāṇḍa vikṛtākṛtayas tu te |
garbhbhā evamvidhāś cānye jñeyāḥ pāpakṛto bhṛśaṃ ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁kūṣmāṇḍa Lkūṃbhāṇḍa A₁₉₃₁ca A₁₉₃₁, Lyeye || ye | A₁₉₃₁, Lgarbhās A₁₉₃₁add tv A₁₉₃₁ete striyāś Ltv etā strīyacś A₁₉₃₁, Lcaiva A₁₉₃₁pāpakṛtā
1931 ed. 3.2.51 garbhbho vātaprakopeṇa dauhṛdena vimānitaḥ |
bhavet kubjo 'thavā kūniḥ paṅgur mmūko 'tha mirmmiṇaḥ ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁, Lgarbho L°pena A₁₉₃₁, Ldauhṛde A₁₉₃₁vāvamānite || Lcāvamānicte | A₁₉₃₁, Lkubjaḥ A₁₉₃₁, Lkuṇiḥ Hni Lpaṃkur A₁₉₃₁mūko Lmmūkho A₁₉₃₁minmina eva vā || Lcdurmmana eva vā |
1931 ed. 3.2.52 mātāpitror anācārād aśubhaiś ca purākṛtaiḥ |
vātādīnām prakopeṇa garbhbho vaikṛtam āpnuyāt ||
K, N Lmātrāpitroś A₁₉₃₁tu nāstikyād Lca nāstikyāt_ Lvātādināñ A₁₉₃₁, Lca kopena A₁₉₃₁garbho Lgarbha A₁₉₃₁vikṛtim Lucyate |
1931 ed. 3.2.53 malālpatvād ayogāc ca vāyoḥ pakvāśayasya ca |
vātamūtrapurīṣāṇi na garbhbhasthaḥ karoti ha ||
K, N Lva || A₁₉₃₁, Lgarbhasthaḥgarbhasthaḥ A₁₉₃₁hi ||
1931 ed. 3.2.54 jarāyunā mukhe cchanne kaṇṭhe ca kaphaveṣṭite |
vāyor ggatinirodhāc ca na garbhbhasthaḥ praroditi ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁jarāyuṇā Ljarāyaṇā Lvāyo A₁₉₃₁mārgani° Lmārgapraro° A₁₉₃₁, Lgarbhasthaḥ Lprarodati |
1931 ed. 3.2.55 niśvāsocchvāsa saṃkṣobha svapnāṅ garbhbho 'tha gacchati |
mātur nniḥśvasitocchvāsasaṃkṣobhasvapnasaṃbhavān ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁niḥśvā° Lom Hsaṃkṣobhaḥ A₁₉₃₁svapnān A₁₉₃₁garbho A₁₉₃₁'dhiga° A₁₉₃₁niśva°
1931 ed. 3.2.56 sanniveśaḥ śarīrāṇāṃ dantānāṃ patanodbhavau |
taleṣv asaṃbhavo yac ca romnām etat svabhāvataḥ ||
K, N Lpātacnokt_bhavau | A₁₉₃₁yaś A₁₉₃₁, Lromṇāmcromṇām
1931 ed. 3.2.57 bhāvitāḥ pūrvvadeheṣu satataṃ śāstrabuddhayaḥ |
bhavanti sattva bahulāḥ pūrvvajātismarā narāḥ || *
K, N Hbhāvitā Hsttāna A₁₉₃₁bhūyiṣṭhāḥ Lpurojā°
    • Witness H has a strange conjunct consonant after bhavanti, followed by na. The whole looks like sttāna, which is not visually similar to sattva. We have followed witness L, which at least make good sense.
K, N A₁₉₃₁add karmaṇā codito yena tad āpnoti punarbhave || abhyastāḥ pūrvadehe ye tān eva bhajate guṇān || Ladd mātrajāni talāny asmād yasmād romṇām asaṃbhava...| pitrajāni pradeśāni bahuromāṇi tatvataḥ ||
iti śārīraṃ dvitīyo 'dhyāyaḥ || ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁add suśrutasaṃhitāyāṃ śārīrasthāne A₁₉₃₁śukraśoṇitaśuddhiśā° Lśarīre A₁₉₃₁add nāma LdviLtiyo

[Adhyāya 3. Draft based on MS H]

1931 ed. 3.3.1 athāto garbbhāvakrāntiṃ śārīraṃ vyākhyāsyāmaḥ ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁°krānti Lgarbhāvakāntīyama
K, N A₁₉₃₁add yathovāca bhagavān dhanvantariḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.3.3 saumyaṃ śukramārttavam āgneyam itareṣām apy atra bhūtānāṃ sānnidhyam asty anunā viśeṣeṇa parasparopakārāt parasparānupraveśāc ca ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁śukram ārtavam Lśukraṃ Ladd ārttavam | Latra py A₁₉₃₁sānnidhyamastyaṇunā Laṇatranām | A₁₉₃₁add parasparānugrahāt
1931 ed. 3.3.4 tatra dampatyoḥ samprayoge tejaḥ śarīrādvāyussamīrayati | tatra tejo 'nilasannipātāc chukraṃ cyutaṃ yonim abhiprapadyate | saṃsṛjyate cārttavena tato 'gnīṣomasaṃyogāt saṃsṛjyamāno garbbhāsayam anuprapadyate kṣettrajñaścetayitā spraṣṭā ghrātā draṣṭā śrotā rasayitā puruṣo gantā sākṣī dhātā vaktā yaḥ ko 'sāvādya āyur ity evam ādibhiḥ paryāyavācakair nnāmabhir abhidhīyate | daivasaṃyogād akṣayo 'vyayo cintyo bhūtātmā satvarajastamobhir ddevāsurair aparaiś ca sahabhāvair vvāyunā preryamāṇo garbbhās ayam anupraviśati ||
K, N Ltat A₁₉₃₁strīpuṃsayoḥ Ltu A₁₉₃₁saṃyoge Lśukam Lom A₁₉₃₁°dvāyurudīrayati, Lstrīpuṃsayos A₁₉₃₁tatastejonilasannipātacchukraṃ Lom H°tāc chukraṃ Lsaṃprayocge A₁₉₃₁yonimabhipratipa° Lom Lom Lom Lom A₁₉₃₁add (garbho?) Lyonau A₁₉₃₁add (garbho?) A₁₉₃₁garbhāśayamanupratipa° Lom A₁₉₃₁kṣetrajño vedayitā Lraja Lom Lom Lom Lom Lvrisuṣṭam A₁₉₃₁add sraṣṭā Lom Lom Lanvakṣacm Lom A₁₉₃₁'sāvityevam Leva Lom Lom A₁₉₃₁°cakairnāmabhir Lbhūtātmanā Lca A₁₉₃₁dainasaṃ(yo?)gādakṣayo Lsaha A₁₉₃₁bhūtātmanā Lbhūtvā A₁₉₃₁add sahānvakṣaṃ A₁₉₃₁daivā° A₁₉₃₁, Lom saha° A₁₉₃₁vāyunā'bhipre° Lvāyunābhipreryyamāṇaṃ Lgarbhāśayam A₁₉₃₁garbhāśayamanupraniśyāvatiṣṭhate || Lāt_myāvatiṣṭhate |
1931 ed. 3.3.5 tatra śukrabāhulyāt pumān ārttavabāhulyāt strī sāmyādubhasakaṃ ||
K, N Lsāmyād ubhayor nnapuṃsakam | A₁₉₃₁°bhayor napuṃsakam A₁₉₃₁add iti ||
1931 ed. 3.3.6 tatra ṛtudvādaśarātraṃ bhavati | tatra prathame divase ṛtumatyāṃ maithunagamanam anāyuṣyam punso bhavati | yac ca tatrādhīyate garbbhaḥ saprasavato vipadyate | dvitīye tikīgṛhe vipadyate || tṛtīye 'py evam asampūrṇṇo 'ṅgo 'lpāmaṃ 3yuś ca bhavati | tasmāt trirātram pariharet | na ca pravarttati raktabījaṃ pradiṣṭaṃ guṇakaraṃ bhavati | yathā nadyām pratisrovidravyaṃ pratikṣiptaṃ na pratinivarttate | tadvad bījaṃ draṣṭavyan tasmāt trirātran niyamavantīm pariharet | tatra ṛtudvādaśarātran dṛṣṭvā nārttavā bhavati | adṛṣṭārttavās tān eke bhāṣante ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁, Lṛtus A₁₉₃₁tu dvā° Ltu dvādaśarāLtran Lom A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁dṛṣṭārtavaḥ; Ldṛṣṭārtavo A₁₉₃₁om Lom A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁om Ladṛṣṭārttavo A₁₉₃₁om Lom A₁₉₃₁adṛṣṭārtavā'py A₁₉₃₁om Lpy Lom Lastīti A₁₉₃₁om Lom A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om Ltad A₁₉₃₁astīty Lom Lom Lom Lom Lom Lom Larvāg A₁₉₃₁om Lom Lhāṣante |
1931 ed. 3.3.9 bhavati cātra ||
dine vyatīte niyataṃ saṃkucaty ambujaṃ yathā |
ṛtau vyatīte nāryās tu yoniḥ saṃkucatis tathā ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁niyataṃ Hom Lom A₁₉₃₁divase 'tīte A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁saṅkucatyambujaṃ A₁₉₃₁saṃvriyate
1931 ed. 3.3.7 pīnaprasannavadanām praklinnātmamukhadvijāṃ |
narakāmām priyakathāṃ srastakukṣyakṣimūrddhajām ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁add bhavanti cātra | Hbhavati Lom Hcātra ||
sphuradbhujakucaśroṇinābhyurujaghanasphicāṃ ||
harṣautsukyaparām̐ś caiva vidyād ṛtumatīṃ striyaṃ ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁°nābhyūrujaghanasphicam || H, Lom A₁₉₃₁harśautsukyaparāṃ A₁₉₃₁cāpi A₁₉₃₁vidyādṛtu° A₁₉₃₁iti ||
1931 ed. 3.3.10 māsenopacitaṃ kāle dhamanībhyāṃ yad āgataṃ ||
īṣatkṛṣṇam vigandhañ ca vāyur yonimukhan nayet ||
K, N Lom A₁₉₃₁tadārtavam || A₁₉₃₁vāyuryonimukhaṃ
1931 ed. 3.3.11 tad varṣād dvādaśāt kāle varttamānam asṛkpunaḥ |
jarāpakvaśarīrāṇām pañcāśād vinivarttate ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁tadvarṣāddvāda° Lom A₁₉₃₁vartamānamasṛk punaḥ || A₁₉₃₁add yāti A₁₉₃₁pañcāśataḥ A₁₉₃₁kṣayam ||
1931 ed. 3.3.12 yugmeṣu tu pumān prokto divaseṣv anyathābalā | puṣpakāle śucis tasmād apatyārthī striyaṃ vrajet ||
K, N Lom A₁₉₃₁śucistasmād
1931 ed. 3.3.13 tatra sadyogṛhītagarbbhāyāḥ śramo glāniḥ pipāsā sakthisadanam āṭopaḥ śukraśoṇitayor anubandhaḥ kharasphuraṇaṃ yonyāḥ ||
K, N Lsadyo grahī° A₁₉₃₁°rbhāyā A₁₉₃₁liṅgāni---śramo Lrgāniḥ Lsakthisīdanam A₁₉₃₁om Lāṭopaśukaśo° Lananu° A₁₉₃₁avabandhaḥ A₁₉₃₁om khara° Lgurutā sphu° A₁₉₃₁, Ladd ca A₁₉₃₁yoneḥ || Lyonyā bhavanti |
1931 ed. 3.3.14ab bhavati cātra ||
stanayoḥ kṛṣṇamukhatā romarājyudgamas tathā |
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, H, L
1931 ed. 3.3.14 prasekaḥ sadanañ cāpi garbbhiṇyā liṃgam ucyate ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, H, L
K, N A₁₉₃₁add akāmataśchardayati gandhādudvijate śubhāt || prasekaḥ sadanaṃ cāpi garbhiṇyā liṅgam ucyate || Ladd prasekas sīdanañ cāpi garbhiṇyā liṃcgam muddhyate |
1931 ed. 3.3.16 tataḥ prabhṛty eva ca vyavāyaṃ vyāyāmam atikarṣanaṃ | divāsvapnaṃ rātrijāgaraṇaṃ śokaṃ yān ārohaṇam bhayamutkaṭakāsanañ caikāntataḥ snehādikramaṃ śoṇitamokṣaṇañ cākālenāseveta |
K, N A₁₉₃₁tadā A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁vyāyāmamatitarpaṇamatikarśanaṃ Lapakarśanam | Lom A₁₉₃₁yānāro° A₁₉₃₁°tkaṭukāsanaṃ Lom A₁₉₃₁snehādikriyāṃ A₁₉₃₁cākāle vegavidhāraṇaṃ ca na seveta || Lca | na seveta |
K, N A₁₉₃₁add doṣābhighātairgarbhiṇyā yo yo bhāgaḥ prapīḍyate || sa sa bhāgaḥ śiśostasya garbhasthasya prapīḍyate ||
1931 ed. 3.3.18 tatra prathame māse kalalañ jāyate || dvitīye śoṇitoṣṇānilaiḥ pacyamāno mahābhūtānāṃ saṃjāto ghanañ jāyate | granthir yadi pumān | strī cetpeśī | napuṃsakaṃ ced arbbudam bhavati || tṛtīye hastapādaśirasām pañca piṭakā abhinirvarttante | sarvvāṅgapratyaṅgavibhāgaś ca sūkṣmo bhavati || caturthe sarvvāṅgapratyaṅgavibhāgaś ca pravyakto bhavati || pañcame sarvvāṅgapratyaṅgavibhāgaś ca pravyaktataro bhavati | garbbhahṛdapravyaktibhāvāc cetanādhātur abhivyaktekasmāt tatsthānatvād garbbhaś caturthe māse abhiprāyam indriyārtheṣu karoti | dvihṛdayā ca nārī bhavati nimittāny ācakṣate | dvau hṛdayavimānanākukukūniṃṣaṇṛmvāman avikṛtākṣam anakṣam vānārīsutañ janayati | tasmāt sā yad icchet tat tasmai dāpayet | labdhadauhṛdāhivīryavantaṃ cirāyuṣañ janayati ||
K, N Ltataḥ A₁₉₃₁, Lmāsi Lckledo Lmāsi | śīto° A₁₉₃₁śītoṣmānilairabhiprapacyamānānāṃ Lahipa° A₁₉₃₁saṃghāto Lom A₁₉₃₁ghanaḥ Lghanapiṇḍas A₁₉₃₁, Lsaṃjā°sañjā° A₁₉₃₁, Lom A₁₉₃₁add piṇḍaḥ Lstri A₁₉₃₁, Lcet peśīcet peśī, A₁₉₃₁cedarbudamiti; Labudan Lom A₁₉₃₁piṇḍakā Lpiṇḍakānām A₁₉₃₁om abhi° Labhinirvṛtti Laṃga° A₁₉₃₁'ṅga° A₁₉₃₁om Lpravyaktataraḥ | A₁₉₃₁om Lom A₁₉₃₁garbhahṛdayapra° L°dayapravyaktihācvāc A₁₉₃₁abhivyakto bhavati, ka° Labhibuddhataro bhavati A₁₉₃₁, Ltasmādadd tasmādadd tasmāt_ A₁₉₃₁, Lmāsy Lācbhi° A₁₉₃₁dvihṛdayāṃ Ldvihṛdacyāñ A₁₉₃₁nārīṃ Lnārīn A₁₉₃₁add dauhṛdinīm A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁dauhṛdavimānanāt kubjaṃ kuṇiṃ khañjaṃ jaḍaṃ vāmanaṃ Ldauhṛdinīty A₁₉₃₁vikṛtākṣamanakṣaṃ A₁₉₃₁vā nārī sutaṃ Lom Lom Lom A₁₉₃₁add yad Lom Lom A₁₉₃₁add tat A₁₉₃₁tasyai Lom Lom Lom A₁₉₃₁°dā hi vīryavantaṃ Lācakṣate | A₁₉₃₁add ca putraṃ
1931 ed. 3.3.19 bhavati cātra || indriyārthām̐s tu yānyāṃ sā bhoktumicchati garbbhiṇī | garbbhābādhabhayāt tām̐s tām bhiṣag āhṛtya dāpayet ||
K, N Lom A₁₉₃₁°rthāṃs A₁₉₃₁yān yān A₁₉₃₁tāṃs A₁₉₃₁tān
1931 ed. 3.3.20 samprāptadauhṛdam putram prajāyeta guṇānvitaṃ | alabdhadauhṛdāgarbbhe labhate cātmanivābhayam ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁sā prāptadauhṛdā Lom A₁₉₃₁janayeta A₁₉₃₁°dā garbhe A₁₉₃₁labhetātmani vā bhayam ||
1931 ed. 3.3.21 yeṣu yeṣv indriyārtheṣu dauhṛdeyāvimānitā | prajāyeta sutaṃ sārttin tasmin tasmin tathendriye ||
K, N Lom A₁₉₃₁dauhṛde vai vimānanā || A₁₉₃₁sutasyārtistasmiṃstasmiṃstathendriye ||
1931 ed. 3.3.22 rājā sandarśane yasyā daurhṛdañ jāyate striyaḥ | arthavantam mahābhāgaṃ kumāraṃ sā prasūyate ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁rājasan° Lom A₁₉₃₁striyāḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.3.23 dukūlapaṭṭakauṣeyabhūṣaṇādiṣu dauhṛdā | alaṅkāreṣiṇam putraṃ lalitaṃ sā prasūyate ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁dukūlapaṭṭakauśeya° Lom A₁₉₃₁dauhṛdāt || A₁₉₃₁alaṅkāraiṣiṇaṃ
1931 ed. 3.3.24 āsrame saṃyatātmānaṃ dharmmaśīlaṃ prajāyate | devatāpratimāyāṃ tu prasūto harṣadopamam || darśane vyāḍajātīnāṃ hiṃsāśīlaṃ prajāyate ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁āśrame Lom A₁₉₃₁prasūyate || A₁₉₃₁prasūte A₁₉₃₁pārṣa° A₁₉₃₁vyālajā° A₁₉₃₁prasūyate ||
1931 ed. 3.3.25 godhāmāṃsāśinīputraṃ suṣupsurmmāraṇātmakaṃ || gavāṃ māṃsena balinaṃ sarvvakleśasahaṃ sutaṃ |
K, N A₁₉₃₁°sāśane putraṃ Lom A₁₉₃₁suṣupsuṃ dhāra° A₁₉₃₁māṃse A₁₉₃₁add tu A₁₉₃₁tathā ||
1931 ed. 3.3.26 māhiṣe daurhṛdāc chūraṃ raktākṣaṃ lomaśaṃ sutaṃ ||
K, N Lom A₁₉₃₁lomasaṃyutam || varāhamāṃsāt svapnāluṃ śūraṃ A₁₉₃₁add saṃjanayet
K, N A₁₉₃₁add mārgādvikrāntajaṅghālaṃ sadā vanacaraṃ sutam || sṛmarādvignimanasaṃ nityabhītaṃ ca taittirāt ||
1931 ed. 3.3.28 ato bhukteṣu yā nārīmabhidhyāyati daurhṛdam | || śarīrāhāraśīlaiḥ sā samānañ janayiṣyati ||
K, N Lom A₁₉₃₁'nukteṣu A₁₉₃₁nārī samabhidhyāti A₁₉₃₁śarīrācāra°
1931 ed. 3.3.29 karmmaṇā coditañjantor bbhavitavyam punar bbhavet | yathā tathā daivayogād daurhṛdañ janayed dhṛdi ||
K, N Lom A₁₉₃₁coditaṃ jantor
1931 ed. 3.3.30 pañcame manaḥpratibuddhataram bhavati || ṣaṣṭhe buddhiḥ saptame sarvvapravyaktaṃ śarīraṃ || aṣṭame sthirībhavaty ojas tatra jāto na jīvati || nairṛtabhāgadheyatvāt tato balim mānsodanaṃ bhāgadheyan tasmai dāpayet || navamadaśamaikādaśadvādaśānām anyatamasmiñ jāyate | atho nyathāvikārī bhavati ||
K, N Lmanaḥ pra° A₁₉₃₁sarvāṅgapratyaṅgavibhāgaḥ pravyaktataraḥ, L°vyaktaśarīraḥ A₁₉₃₁aṣṭame+asthi° Lom A₁₉₃₁add cen Ladd ca A₁₉₃₁jīven nirojastvān- Ljīven Lnainṛtibhāgatvāt A₁₉₃₁°gatvāc A₁₉₃₁add ca , Lom Lom A₁₉₃₁māṃsaudanamasmai Lnavaman Lom Ldaśamaikādaśa | dvā° A₁₉₃₁°masmin A₁₉₃₁ato A₁₉₃₁, Lnyathā vi°'nyathā vi°
1931 ed. 3.3.31 mātus tu khalu rasavahāyānnābhyāṃ garbbhanāḍī pratibaddhā bhavati | māturāhārarasavīryam abhyavaharati || tenopasnehenābhivṛddhir asya bhavati | asañjātāṅgavibhāgam api niḥṣekānprabhṛtisarvvaśarīrānusāriṇīnāṃ rasavahānāṃ tiryaggatīnān dhamanīnām upasnehena jīvayati ||
K, N Lgarbhayarāyān nāḍyāṃ A₁₉₃₁°yāṃ nāḍyāṃ A₁₉₃₁garbhanābhināḍī Lgarbhanābhināḻī A₁₉₃₁, Lsāsyasā'sya A₁₉₃₁, Lmātur āhā° A₁₉₃₁abhivahati | Labhivahanti | A₁₉₃₁°nāsyābhivṛddhir A₁₉₃₁om Ladd ca Lbhavacnti | A₁₉₃₁asaṃjātāṅgapratyaṅgapravibhāgamāniṣekāt prabhṛti sarvaśarīrāvayavānu° Labhiniṣekāt cprabhṛti sa° Lrasacvāhinīnām_ A₁₉₃₁tiryaggatānāṃ Ltiryyaggatānān A₁₉₃₁, Lupasneho
1931 ed. 3.3.32 garbbhasya khalu sambhavataḥ || pūrvvaṃ śiraḥ sambhavatīty āha śaunakas tanmūlatvāt | yāṇāṃ hṛdayam iti kṛtavīryaḥ | buddher manasaś ca sthānaṃ nābhir iti pārāsaryas tato varddhate derahadehinaḥ | prāṇaḥ pāṇipādam iti mārkkaṇḍeyas tanmūlatvāc ceṣṭāyāḥ | garbbhasya śarīram iti || subhūtigautamas tatra nibandhatvāt sarvvagātrasambhavasya tan tu na samyak sarvvāṇy aṅgapratyaṅgāni yugapat sambhavanti | kāle garbbhasya sūkṣmatvān nopalabhyante | vaṃśāṅkuravac cūtaphalavac ca | tad yathā cūtaphalevipakve keśararamānsāsthimajjānaḥ pṛthak pṛthag dṛśyante kālaprakarṣāttānyeva taruṇenopalabhyante || sūkṣmatvāt teṣāṃ sūkṣmāṇāṃ keśarādīnām pravyaktaṃ kālaḥ karoti | etenaiva vaṃśāṃkuro vyākhyātaḥ | evaṃ garbbhasya tāruṇye sarvveṣv aṅgapratyaṅgeṣu satsv api saukṣmyād anupalabdhis tāny eva kālaprakarṣāt pravyaktāni bhavanti |
K, N Lom A₁₉₃₁°tītyāha A₁₉₃₁śiromū° A₁₉₃₁-pradhānendriyāṇāṃ; A₁₉₃₁buddhermanasaś A₁₉₃₁sthānatvāt ; A₁₉₃₁pārāśaryaḥ, A₁₉₃₁add hi A₁₉₃₁deho de° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°tvācceṣṭāyā A₁₉₃₁madhyaśa° A₁₉₃₁subhūtirgautamaḥ, A₁₉₃₁tannibaddha° A₁₉₃₁tat Htantu Ladd eva A₁₉₃₁saṃbhavantīty A₁₉₃₁āha Lpūrvottarakālayogo A₁₉₃₁add dhanvantariḥ, A₁₉₃₁sūkṣmatvānno° Lom A₁₉₃₁tadyathā---cūtaphale paripakve Lom A₁₉₃₁keśaramāṃsāsthi° Lnāsti | Lom Lom Lom Lkevalan A₁₉₃₁°rṣāt; tāny eva A₁₉₃₁taruṇe no° Ltu Lsaukṣmyān Lom A₁₉₃₁add kālaḥ A₁₉₃₁pravyaktatāṃ A₁₉₃₁om Lom A₁₉₃₁vaṃśāṅkuro 'pi Lom Lnābhivyajyate | Lom Lom Lom Lom Lom Lom A₁₉₃₁saukṣmyādanu° Lyathākālaṃ A₁₉₃₁tānyeva
1931 ed. 3.3.33 pūrvvottarakālayogo nāstīti kevalan tu saukṣmyān nābhivyajyante | yathākālaṃ pravyaktāni bhavanti | tatra pitṛjamātṛjarasajātmajasatvasātmyajāni śarīre lakṣaṇāni vakṣyāmaḥ || tatra keśasmaśrudantanakharomāsthiretaḥprabhṛtīni pitṛjāni || māṃsaśoṇitamedomajjāhṛnnābhiyakṛtplīhāntragudaprabhṛtīni mṛdūni mātṛjāni | śarīropacayo balavṛddhir vvarṇṇasthitihāniś ca rasajāni | indriyāṇi jñānam āyuḥ sukhaduḥkhādikaṃ cātmanaḥ satvajāny uttaratra vakṣyāmaḥ | vīryamārogyam balaṃ varṇṇo medhā ca sātmyajaṃ ||
K, N Lom A₁₉₃₁tatra Lom Lom Lom Lgarbhasya A₁₉₃₁garbhasya A₁₉₃₁°ttvajasātmyajāni A₁₉₃₁śarīrala° A₁₉₃₁vyākhyāsyāmaḥ | A₁₉₃₁garbhasya, Ltu A₁₉₃₁keśaśmaśrulomāsthinakhadantasirāsnāyudhamanīre° Lkeśaśmaśrulocunakhāsthipra° A₁₉₃₁, Ladd sthirāṇi A₁₉₃₁māṃsaśoṇitamedomajjahṛ° L°majjaprabhṛtinī A₁₉₃₁balaṃ Lbalaṃ praddhi A₁₉₃₁varṇaḥ sthitir hāniś Lsthitir hāniś Lrajasāni | āyurācrogyaṃ A₁₉₃₁vijñānamāyuḥ Lmedhāsukhaduḥkhañ A₁₉₃₁cātmajāni, Lcātmajāni | A₁₉₃₁sattvajānyutta° Lom A₁₉₃₁balavarṇau A₁₉₃₁sātmyajāni ||
1931 ed. 3.3.34 tatra yasyādakṣiṇe stane prākpayaso darśanaṃ | dakṣiṇakukṣimahatvañ ca pūrvvadakṣiṇaṃ sakthi utkarṣayati | bāhulyāc ca punnāmadheyeṣu dravyeṣu daurhṛdam abhidhyāyati | svapne copalabhate padmotpalakumudāmrāmrātakādīni pun nāmany eva vā prasannamukhavarṇṇā ca bhavetāṃ brūyāt putram iyam prajanayiṣyatīti || tad viparyaye kanyāṃ || yasyāḥ pārśvadvayam avanatam purastān nirggatam udaraṃ prāgabhihitañ ca lakṣaṇan tasyāḥ | napuṃsakam iti vidyāt | yasyā madhye nimno droṇī prābhūtamuyugmaṃ prasūyata iti ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁, Lyasyā da° Lprāk payaso A₁₉₃₁prāk payoda° A₁₉₃₁add bhavati A₁₉₃₁dakṣiṇākṣi° Ldakṣiṇapārśvaṃ Ladd saṃśritaś Ladd garbhaḥ A₁₉₃₁pūrvaṃ ca da° Lgratau cdakṣiṇā A₁₉₃₁, Lsakthyutkarṣatisakthyutkarṣati A₁₉₃₁vāhu° Lbāhuś Lom Ldaurhṛdeṣu yā A₁₉₃₁daurhṛdamabhi° Lsābhilāṣā bhavati | A₁₉₃₁svapneṣu Lom A₁₉₃₁°dāmrātakādīni A₁₉₃₁punnāmanyeva Lpunnāmānyeva A₁₉₃₁, Lom Lprasanno mukhavarṇṇaś A₁₉₃₁bhavati tāṃ Ltām_ A₁₉₃₁putramiyaṃ A₁₉₃₁, Lom pra° A₁₉₃₁, Ltadvipa° Lkannyām | Lom A₁₉₃₁pārśvadvayamunnataṃ A₁₉₃₁purastānnirgatamudaraṃ A₁₉₃₁°hitalakṣaṇaṃ A₁₉₃₁add ca A₁₉₃₁nimnaṃ A₁₉₃₁droṇībhūtamudaraṃ sā yugmaṃ
1931 ed. 3.3.35 bhavati cātra || devatā brāhmaṇaparāḥ śucyo hitam itāśanāḥ | mahāguṇāḥ prasūyante viparītās tu nirgguṇāḥ ||
K, N A₁₉₃₁, Lbhavanti Ladd ślokaḥ | A₁₉₃₁devatābrā° Ldaivatabrāhmaṇaparā A₁₉₃₁śaucācārahite Lśuddhyāhitamitāśani | A₁₉₃₁ratāḥ || A₁₉₃₁mahāguṇān Lmahāguṇam_ Lprasūyeta Lviparītā Lca A₁₉₃₁nirguṇān || Lnirguṇam |
1931 ed. 3.3.36 aṅgapratyaṅganirvṛttiḥ svabhāvād evajāyate | aṃgapratyaṃganirvṛttā ye bhavanti guṇāguṇāḥ || te vai garbbhasya vijñeyā dharmmādharmmanimittajāḥ ||
K, N L°rvṛtti A₁₉₃₁, Leva jā° Lguṇa A₁₉₃₁°rvṛttau Ltv Lom A₁₉₃₁te Lasya Lte cjñeyā

iti śārīratṛtīyo 'dhyāyaḥ ||

[Adhyāya 4. Draft based on MS H]

1931 ed. 3.4.1 athāto garbhavyākaraṇaṃ śārīraṃ vyākhyāsyāmaḥ ||
K, N, L Hgarvbhavyā° A₁₉₃₁add (nāma)
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add yathovāca bhagavān dhavantariḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.4.3 1931 ed. śā.4.3 agnīṣomo vāyuḥ satvaṃ rajas tamaḥ | pañcendriyāṇi bhūtātmānaś ceti prāṇāḥ |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁agniḥ somo A₁₉₃₁rajastamaḥ A₁₉₃₁bhūtātmeti
1931 ed. 3.4.4 tasya khalu śukraśoṇitasyābhipacyamānasya kṣīrasyeva hi santānikāḥ saptatvaco bhavanti || tasāṃ prathamo vabhāsinī nāma yā sarvvavarṇṇān avabhāsayati | pañcavidhāñ ca cchāyām prakāśayati | sā vrīher aṣṭādaśabhāgapramāṇā | dvitīyā lohitā nāma ṣoḍaśabhāgapramāṇā | tṛtīyā śvetā dvādaśabhāgapramāṇā | carurthī tāmrāṣṭabhāgapramāṇā | pañcamī vedanī nāma pañcabhāgapramāṇā | ṣaṣṭhī rohiṇī nāma vrīhipramāṇā | saptamī śukradharā nāma vrīhidvayapramāṇā || yato vakṣyatyudare vrīhimukhenāṅgulamaṅguṣṭhodaramātram vāvagāhyeti
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁khalvevaṃpravṛttasya A₁₉₃₁add mānasya A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁sapta tvaco A₁₉₃₁prathamā A₁₉₃₁add siddhmapadmakaṃṭakādhiṣṭhānā; A₁₉₃₁vrīhiṣo° A₁₉₃₁add tilakalakanyacchavyaṅgādhiṣṭhānā; A₁₉₃₁nāma,vrīhidvā° A₁₉₃₁add carmadalājagallīmaśakādhiṣṭhānā; A₁₉₃₁tāmrā nāma vrīheraṣṭa° A₁₉₃₁add vividhakilāsakuṣṭhādhiṣṭhānā; A₁₉₃₁vedinī A₁₉₃₁vrīhipañ° A₁₉₃₁add kuṣṭhavisarpādhiṣṭhānā; A₁₉₃₁add granthyapacyarbudaślīpadagalagaṇḍādhiṣṭhānā; A₁₉₃₁māṃsadharā A₁₉₃₁add bhagandaravidradhyarśo 'dhiṣṭhānā | yadetat pramāṇaṃ nirdiṣṭaṃ tanmāṃsaleṣv avakāśeṣu, na lalāṭe sūkṣmāṅgulyādiṣu; A₁₉₃₁°reṣu---vrīhimukhenāṅguṣṭhodarapramāṇamavagāḍhaṃ A₁₉₃₁vidhyediti ||
1931 ed. 3.4.5 kalāḥ khalvapi sapta sambhavanti dhātvāntarāśayamaryādāḥ || ślokau ||
K, N, L Hkhalv api A₁₉₃₁dhātvāśayāntarama° A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.4.6 yathā hi sāraḥ kāṣṭheṣu chidyamāneṣu dṛśyate | tathā hi dhātur mmāṃseṣu cchidyamāneṣu dṛśyate ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add bhavataś cātra | A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁dhāturhi
1931 ed. 3.4.7 snāyubhiś ca praticchannāṃ santatāṃś ca jarāyuṇā | śleṣmaṇā veṣṭitām̐ś cāpi kalābhāgām vidur vvudhāḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁praticchannān A₁₉₃₁veṣṭitāṃś A₁₉₃₁kalābhāgāṃs A₁₉₃₁tu A₁₉₃₁add tān A₁₉₃₁viduḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.4.8 tāsaṃ prathamā māṃsadhārā nāma | tasyā māṃsasirāsnāyudhamanīsrotasān navanavapratāni bhavanti ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁yasyāṃ A₁₉₃₁māṃse sirāsnāyudhamanīsrotasāṃ A₁₉₃₁pratānā
1931 ed. 3.4.9 bhavati || yathā viṣamṛṇālāni vivarddhante samantataḥ | bhūmau paṃkodakasthāni tathā mānse sirādayaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add cātra | A₁₉₃₁bisamṛ° A₁₉₃₁māṃse
1931 ed. 3.4.10 dvitīyā raktadharā nāma mānsasyābhyantaratas tasyā śoṇitam viśeṣataḥ sirāsu ca yakṛtplīhnoś ca bhavati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁māṃsasyā° A₁₉₃₁tasyāṃ A₁₉₃₁add ca A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.4.11 || bha || vṛkṣādyathā hi prahatāt kṣīriṇaḥ kṣīram āmrayet | mānsādevaṃ kṣatāt kṣipraṃ śoṇitaṃ sampravartate ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁bhavati cātra | A₁₉₃₁vṛkṣādyathābhipra° A₁₉₃₁kṣīramāvahet || A₁₉₃₁māṃsādevaṃ A₁₉₃₁saṃprasicyate ||
1931 ed. 3.4.12 tṛtīyā medodharā nāma medas tu khalu sarvvabhūtānām udareṣv asthiṣu ca mahatsu cāntarmmajjā ca bhavati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁hi A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°tānāmudarasthamaṇvasthiṣu A₁₉₃₁ca majjā A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.4.13 bha || sthūlāsthiṣu viśeṣeṇa majjā tv abhyantarāsritaḥ | athetareṣu sarvveṣu saraktaṃ meda ucyate ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁bhavati cātra | A₁₉₃₁tvabhyantarāśritaḥ || A₁₉₃₁add śuddhamāṃsasya yaḥ snehaḥ sā vasā parikīrtitā ||
1931 ed. 3.4.14 caturthī śleṣmadharā nāma yā .......sandhiṣu sarvvaprāṇapratām bhavati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁sarvasan° A₁₉₃₁prāṇabhṛtāṃ
1931 ed. 3.4.15 bha || snehābhyakte yathā hy akṣe cakraṃ sādhu pravarttate | sandhayaḥ sādhu varttante saṃśliṣṭā śleṣmaṇā tathā ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁bhavati cātra | A₁₉₃₁saṃśliṣṭāḥ
1931 ed. 3.4.16 pañcamī purīṣadharā nāma yā caturvvidham apy annamāmāśayāt pracyutam pakvāsayopasthitaṃ dhārayati | koṣṭham vibhajati pakvāsayasthā ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁yā'vtaḥkoṣṭhe A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁malamabhivibhajate A₁₉₃₁pakvāśayasthā ||
1931 ed. 3.4.17 bha || yakṛtsamantāt koṣṭhañ ca tathāntrāṇi samāsritāḥ | uṇḍukaccham vibhajate malam maladharā kalāḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁bhavati cātra | A₁₉₃₁samāśritā || A₁₉₃₁uṇḍukasthaṃ A₁₉₃₁kalā ||
1931 ed. 3.4.18 ṣaṣṭhī pittadharā nāma yā caturvvidham aśitapītakādita līḍham iti pacati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁caturvidhamannapānam A₁₉₃₁add upabhu(yu)ktamāmāśayāt A₁₉₃₁pracyutaṃ pakvāśayopasthitaṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁dhārayati ||
1931 ed. 3.4.19 bhavati cātra || aśitaṃ khāditaṃ pītaṃ līḍhaṃ yat koṣṭhagataṃ || tajjīryatiyathākālaṃ śoṣitam pittatejasā ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁add nṛṇām || A₁₉₃₁tajjīryati ya°
1931 ed. 3.4.20 saptamī śukradharā nāma yā sarvvaprāṇināṃ sarvvaśarīravyāpinī bhavati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.4.21 bhavati cātra || yathā payasi sarppis tu guḍaś cekṣurase 'iti yathā | śarīreṣu tathā śukraṃ nṛṇām vidyādbhiṣagvaraḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁bhavanti A₁₉₃₁gūḍhaścekṣau raso
1931 ed. 3.4.22 dvyaṅgule dakṣiṇe pārśve vastidvārasya cāpy avāddhu | mūtrasrotas tataḥ śukraṃ puruṣasya pravarttate ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁basti° A₁₉₃₁cāpyadhaḥ || A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°taḥpathāccgukraṃ
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add kṛtsnadehāśritaṃ śukraṃ prasannamanasas tathā || strīṣu vyāyacchataś cāpi harśāttat saṃpravartate ||
1931 ed. 3.4.24 gṛhītagarvbhāṇām ārttavavahānāṃ srotasāṃ vartmāṇy uparuddhāni garbheṇa bhavanti || tasmād gṛhītagarvbhāṇām ārttavaṃ na tu dṛśyate | tatas tad adhaḥ pratihatagatyūrddhvabhāgam upari copacīyamānam udare mucyate | śeṣaṃ corddhatarabhāgam āgatam payodharāv abhipratipadyete | tasmād garvbhiṇyaḥ pīnonnatapayodharā bhavanti ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁gṛhītagarbhāṇāmārta° A₁₉₃₁vartmānyavarudhyanta A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°garbhāṇāmārtavaṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁tatastadadhaḥ A₁₉₃₁°tamūrdhvamāgatamaparaṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°mānamaparāîtyabhidhīyate; A₁₉₃₁cordhvataramāgataṃ A₁₉₃₁payodharāvabhipratipadyate, A₁₉₃₁garbhiṇyaḥ
1931 ed. 3.4.25 yakṛtplīhānau śoṇitajau | śoṇitaphenaprabhavaḥ phupphusaḥ śoṇitakiṭṭaprabhavaḥ | uṇḍukaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add garbhasya A₁₉₃₁°bhabhavaḥ A₁₉₃₁śoṇitāṃkaṭṭaprabhabhva
1931 ed. 3.4.26 bhavati cātra || asṛjaḥ śleṣmaṇaś cāpi yaḥ prasādaḥ paro mataḥ | taṃ pacyamānaṃ pittena vātaś cāpy anudhāvati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁asṛjaḥ A₁₉₃₁vāyuś A₁₉₃₁cāpyanu°
1931 ed. 3.4.27 tato 'syāntrāṇi jāyante gude vastiś ca dehinaḥ | tatrāsya mathyamānasya dhāmyamānasya rugmavat ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁gudaṃ A₁₉₃₁bastiś A₁₉₃₁udare A₁₉₃₁pacyamānānāmādhmānādrukmasāravat ||
1931 ed. 3.4.28 jantoḥ saṃjāyate jihvā yayā vedayate rasān ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁kaphaśoṇitamāṃsānāṃ A₁₉₃₁sāro A₁₉₃₁prajāyate || A₁₉₃₁add yathārthamūṣmaṇā yukto vāyuḥ srotāṃsi A₁₉₃₁dārayet ||
1931 ed. 3.4.29 1931 ed. śā.4.29
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add anupraviśya piśitaṃ peśīrvibhajate tathā || medasaḥ snehamādāya sirāsnāyutvamāpnuyāt ||
1931 ed. 3.4.30 1931 ed. śā.4.30
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add sirāṇāṃ tu mṛduḥ pākaḥ snāyūnāṃ ca tataḥ kharaḥ || āśayyābhyāsayogena karotyāśayasaṃbhavam ||
1931 ed. 3.4.31 śoṇitakaphaprasādajaṃ hṛdayaṃ | yadāsrayā hi dhamanyaḥ prāṇavahās tad viśeṣeṇa cetanāsthānam uktaṃ || tasmim̐stamasāvṛte sarvvaprāṇinaḥ svapanti ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add raktamedaḥprasādādvṛkkau; māṃsāsṛkkalhamedaḥprasādādvṛṣaṇau; A₁₉₃₁yadāśrayā A₁₉₃₁add tasyādho A₁₉₃₁vāmataḥ A₁₉₃₁add plīhā phupphusaśca, dakṣiṇato yakṛt kloma ca; taddhṛdayaṃ A₁₉₃₁atastasmiṃstamasā 'vṛte
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add bhavati cātra | puṇḍarīkeṇa sadṛśaṃ hṛdayaṃ syādadhomukham || jāgratastadvikasati svapataś ca nimīlati ||
1931 ed. 3.4.33 nidrān tu vaiṣṇaṃ vīpāpmānam upadiśanti | sā svabhāvataḥ sarvvaprāṇino nispṛśati | tatra yadā saṃjñāvahāni srotānsi tamobhūyiṣṭhaḥ śleṣmā pratipadyate || tadā tāmasī nāma nidrā bhavatyanavabodhinī sā pralayakāle tamobhūyiṣṭhānāmahaḥsu ca niśāsu bhavati | rajobhūyiṣṭhā nāma nimittasatvabhūyiṣṭhānām ardharātre kṣīṇaśleṣmaṇām anilavahulānām mano bhighātāc ca vaikārikī ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁nidrāṃ A₁₉₃₁vaiṣṇavīṃ A₁₉₃₁om vī° A₁₉₃₁svabhāvata A₁₉₃₁add eva A₁₉₃₁'bhis pṛśati | A₁₉₃₁srotāṃsi A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁add ca A₁₉₃₁°ṣṭhānāmanimittaṃ, sattvabhūyiṣṭhānāmardharātre; A₁₉₃₁°ṣmanilabahulānāṃ A₁₉₃₁manaḥśarīrābhitāpavatāṃ A₁₉₃₁add naiva, sā A₁₉₃₁add bhavati ||
1931 ed. 3.4.34 bhavanti cātra || hṛdayañ cetanāsthānaṃ muktaṃ suśruta dehinām | tamobhibhūte tasmiṃs tu nidrā viśati dehinaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°sthānamuktaṃ A₁₉₃₁dehinam ||
1931 ed. 3.4.35 nidrāhetustamaḥ sattvaṃ bodhane heturucyate | svabhāva eva vā hetur ggarīyān parikīrtyate ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁heturgarī°
1931 ed. 3.4.36 pūrvvadehānubhūtām̐s tu bhūtātmā svapiti prabhuḥ || rajoyuktena manasā gṛhṇīte rthāṃ śubhāśubhāṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°tāṃs A₁₉₃₁svapataḥ A₁₉₃₁gṛhṇātyarthān A₁₉₃₁śubhāśubhān ||
1931 ed. 3.4.37 karaṇānāṃ tu vaiguṇye tamasā bhipravarttate | asvapann api bhūtātmā prasupta iti cocyate ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁vaikalye A₁₉₃₁tamasā'bhipravardhite || A₁₉₃₁asvapannapi A₁₉₃₁iva
1931 ed. 3.4.38 sarvvarttuṣu ca divāsvapnam pratiṣiddho 'nyatra grīṣmāt | pratiṣiddheṣv api pratiṣiddho vālavṛddhakṣatakṣīṇamadyapītastrīyānavāhanādhvakarmmapariśrāntānām | abhuktavatāṃ medomārutakapharasakṣīṇānāṃ muhūrttam praśaṃsanti | rātrāv api khalu jāgaritavatāṃ jāgaraṇakālārddhan divāsvapet | vikṛtis tu divāsvapno nāma tatra svapatāmadharmmaḥ sarvvadoṣaprakopaś ca tat prakopāt kāsaś cāsapratiśyāyaśiro gauravāṅgamarddārocakāgnidaurvvalyāni bhavanti | rātrāv api khalu jāgaritavatāntanimittāsta eva doṣāḥ prādurbhavanti ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁divāsvāpaḥ A₁₉₃₁tu A₁₉₃₁bālavṛddhastrīkarśitakṣatakṣīṇamadyanityayānavāhanādhvakarmapariśrāntānāmabhu° A₁₉₃₁medaḥsvedakapharasaraktakṣīṇānāmajīrṇināṃ A₁₉₃₁add ca A₁₉₃₁divāsvapanamapratiṣiddham | A₁₉₃₁rātrāvapi A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁jāgaritakālādardhamiṣyate A₁₉₃₁divāsvapanam | A₁₉₃₁vikṛtirhi A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°kopaśca, A₁₉₃₁tatprakopācca A₁₉₃₁kāsaśvāsapratiśyāyaśiro-gauravāṅgamardārocakajvarāgnidaurbalyāni A₁₉₃₁rātrāvapi A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°tāṃ vātapittanimittāsta A₁₉₃₁evopadravā A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁bhavanti || Hprādurvbhavanti ||
1931 ed. 3.4.39 bhavanti cātra ślokāḥ || tasmān na jāgṛyād rātrau divā svapnañ ca varjjayet | jñātvā doṣakarāv etau vudhaḥ svapnam itaś caret mitaṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁tasmānna A₁₉₃₁jāgṛyādrātrau A₁₉₃₁divāsvapnaṃ A₁₉₃₁doṣakarāvetau A₁₉₃₁budhaḥ A₁₉₃₁mitaṃ A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.4.40 tathā hy aro...ḥ sumanā valavarṇṇānvitā bhṛśaṃ | nātisthūlakṛṣaḥ śrīmān naro jīvet samā śataṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁arogaḥ A₁₉₃₁add hyevaṃ A₁₉₃₁balavarṇānvito A₁₉₃₁vṛṣaḥ || A₁₉₃₁°kṛśaḥ A₁₉₃₁samāḥ
1931 ed. 3.4.56 mūrcchā pittatamaḥ prāyā rajaḥpittānilādbhramaḥ | tamovātakaphātandrā nidrā śleṣmatamobhavā ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°maḥprāyā, A₁₉₃₁°phāttandrā,
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add nidrā sātmyīkṛtā yais tu rātrau ca yadi vā divā || (divārātrau ca ye nityaṃ svapnajāgaraṇocitāḥ |) na teṣāṃ svapatāṃ doṣo jāgratāṃ vā'pi jāyate ||
1931 ed. 3.4.42 nidrānāśonilāt pittātmanas tāpāt kṣayādapi | abhighātāc ca bhavati pratyanīkaiḥ sa śāmyati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁nidrānāśo 'ni° A₁₉₃₁pittānmanastāpāt A₁₉₃₁saṃbhavatyabhi° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁praśāmyati ||
1931 ed. 3.4.43 1931 ed. śā.4.43 nidrānāśe 'bhyaṅgayogo mūrdhni tailaniṣevaṇam || gātrasyodvartanaṃ caiva hitaṃ saṃvāhanāni ca ||
K, N, L
1931 ed. 3.4.44 1931 ed. śā.4.44 śāligodhūmapiṣṭānnabhakṣyairaikṣavasaṃskṛtaiḥ || bhojanaṃ madhuraṃ snigdhaṃ kṣīramāṃsarasādibhiḥ ||
K, N, L
1931 ed. 3.4.45 1931 ed. śā.4.45 rasairbileśayānāṃ ca viṣkirāṇāṃ tathaiva ca || drākṣāsitekṣudravyāṇām upayogo bhavenniśi ||
K, N, L
1931 ed. 3.4.46 1931 ed. śā.4.46 śayanāsanayānāni manojñāni mṛduni ca || nidrānāśe tu kurvīta tathā'nyānyapi buddhimān ||
K, N, L
1931 ed. 3.4.47 nidrātiyoge vamanaṃ hitaṃ saṃśodhanāni ca | laṃghanaṃ raktamokṣaś ca manovyākulanāni ca ||
K, N, L
1931 ed. 3.4.48 kaphamedoviṣārttānāṃ rātrau jāgaraṇaṃ hitam | divāsvapnaś ca bhṛṭchūlahikkājīrṇṇātisāriṇāṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁tṛṭśūla°
1931 ed. 3.4.49 1931 ed. śā.4.49 indriyārtheṣv asamvittir jjṛmbhanaṃ gauravaṃ klamaḥ | nidrārttasyaiva yasyehā tasya tandrā vinirddiśet ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁asaṃprāptirgauravaṃ A₁₉₃₁jṛmbhaṇaṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁nidrārtasyeva A₁₉₃₁tandrāṃ
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add pītvaikamanilocchvāsamudveṣṭan vivṛtānanaḥ || yaṃ muñcati sanetrāsraṃ sa jṛmbha iti saṃjñitaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add yo 'nāyāsaḥ śramo dehe pravṛddhaḥ śvāsavarjitaḥ || klamaḥ sa iti vijñeya indriyārthaprabādhakaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add sukhasparśaprasaṅgitvaṃ duḥkhadveṣaṇalolatā || śaktasya cāpyanutsāhaḥ karmasvālasyamucyate ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add utkliśyānnaṃ na nirgacchet prasekaṣṭhīvaneritam || hṛdayaṃ pīḍyate cāsya tamutkleśaṃ vinirdiśet ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add vaktre madhuratā tandrā hṛdayodveṣṭanaṃ bhramaḥ || na cānnamabhikāṅkṣeta glāniṃ tasya vinirdiśet ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add ārdracarbhāvanaddhaṃ vā(hi)yo gātramabhimanyate || tathā guru śiro 'tyarthaṃ gauravaṃ tadvinirdiśet ||
1931 ed. 3.4.57 garbhasya khalu rasaguṇanimittātmā turāhāranimittā ca parivṛddhir bhavati ||
K, N, L Hgarvbhasya A₁₉₃₁rasanimittā mārutādhmānani° Hparivṛddhirvbhavati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add bhavanti cātra | tasyāntareṇa nābhes tu jyotiḥsthānaṃ dhruvaṃ smṛtam || tadādhamati vātas tu dehastenāsya vardhate ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add ūṣmaṇā sahitaś cāpi dārayatyasya mārutaḥ || ūrdhvaṃ tiryagadhastāc ca srotāṃsyapi yathā tathā ||
1931 ed. 3.4.60 bhavati cātra || dṛṣṭiś ca romakūpāś ca vardhante na kadācana | dhruvāṇy etāni marttyānām iti dhanvantarer mmataṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁add na A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁dhruvāṇyetāni A₁₉₃₁dhanvantarermatam ||
1931 ed. 3.4.61 śarīre kṣīyamāṇe pi varddhate dvāv imau sadā | svabhāvam prakṛtiṅ kṛtvā nakhakeśāv iti sthitiḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁vardhete A₁₉₃₁dvāvimau A₁₉₃₁nakhakeśāviti
1931 ed. 3.4.62 tisraḥ prakṛtayo bhavanti vātapittakaphanimittāḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁sapta A₁₉₃₁bhavanti---doṣaiḥ pṛthak, A₁₉₃₁dviśaḥ, samastaiś A₁₉₃₁add ca ||
1931 ed. 3.4.63 śuklaśoṇitasaṃyoge yo doṣas tūtkaṭo bhavet | prakṛtir jjāyate tena tāsāṃ me lakṣaṇaṃ śṛṇu ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁śukraśo° A₁₉₃₁bhaveddoṣa A₁₉₃₁utkaṭaḥ || A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁prakṛtirjāyate A₁₉₃₁tasyā
1931 ed. 3.4.64 tatra vāta prakṛtijāgarūkaḥ śītadveṣī durbhagas tenonāryo mastarogāndharvvaḥ | sphuṭitakaracaraṇau rūkṣālpakeśaḥ smaśruḥ kaṭhimakrodhī dantakhādī alpavalo 'lpāyuś ca bhavati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁yaḥ A₁₉₃₁prajā° Hdurvbhagasteno° A₁₉₃₁steno A₁₉₃₁matsaryanāryo gāndharvacittaḥ A₁₉₃₁°raṇo A₁₉₃₁'lparūkṣaśmaśrunakhakeśaḥ A₁₉₃₁krāthī A₁₉₃₁dantanakhakhādī A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.4.65 bhavati cātra || adhṛtiradṛḍhāsauhṛdayaḥ kṛtaghnaḥ kṛṣaparuṣo dhamanītataḥ pralāpī | drutagatiraṭano navasthitātmā nabhasi ca gacchati saṃbhrameṇa suptaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁adhṛtiradṛḍhasauhṛdaḥ A₁₉₃₁kṛśaparuṣo A₁₉₃₁viyati
1931 ed. 3.4.66 avyavasthitamatiś calacitto mandadantadhanasañcayamitraḥ || kiñcideva vilapaty anivaddhaṃ mārutaprakṛtireṣa manuṣyaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁avyavasthitamatiścaladṛṣṭirmandaratnadha° A₁₉₃₁vilapatyanibaddhaṃ
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add vātikāś cājagomāyuśaśākhūṣṭraśunāṃ tathā || gṛghrakākakharādīnāmanūkaiḥ kīrtitā narāḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.4.68 pittaprakṛtis tu svedanaḥ śītasaho durggandhī pītaḥ kālo vā | śithilāṅgastāmranakhanayanatālujihvauṣṭapādapāṇitalo durbhago valīpalito sṛṣṭo vahubhuguṣṇadveṣī kṣiprakrodhaprasādaśīlo madhyamāyuś ca bhavati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁durgandhaḥ A₁₉₃₁pītaśithilāṅgastāmranakhanayanatālujihvauṣṭhapāṇipādatalo Hdurvbhago A₁₉₃₁valipalitakhālityajuṣṭo A₁₉₃₁bahu° A₁₉₃₁kṣiprakopaprasādo madhyamaṣolo
1931 ed. 3.4.69 bhavati cātra || medhāvī nipuṇamatir nnigṛhya vaktā tejasvī samitiṣu durnnivāravīryaḥ | suptaḥ saṃ kanakapalāśakarṇṇikārāṃ saṃpaśyed api ca hutāśavidyudulkāṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°matirvigṛhya A₁₉₃₁san A₁₉₃₁°kārān A₁₉₃₁°dulkāḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.4.70 na bhayāt praṇamet praṇateṣu mṛduḥ praṇateṣu ca sāṃvanadān aruciḥ | bhavatīha sadā vyathitāsyagatiḥ sa bhaved iha pittakṛtaprakṛtiḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁anateṣv A₁₉₃₁amṛduḥ A₁₉₃₁praṇateṣv A₁₉₃₁api A₁₉₃₁sāntvanadānaruciḥ || H°dānaruciḥ | A₁₉₃₁°sya gatiḥ Hbhavediha
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add bhujaṅgolūkagandharvayakṣamārjāravānaraiḥ || vyāghrarkṣanakulānūkaiḥ paittikās tu narāḥ smṛtāḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.4.72 śleṣmaprakṛtis tu dūrvvedīsvaranistriṃśārddrāriṣṭakaśarakāṇḍānām anyatamavarṇaḥ subhagaḥ priyadarśano madhurapriyaḥ | kṛtajño dhṛtimān sahiṣṇur alolupo valavāṃściragrāhī dṛḍhavairodīrghāyuś ca bhavati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁dūrvendīvara° A₁₉₃₁sahiṣṇuralo° A₁₉₃₁bala° A₁₉₃₁dṛḍhavairaś
1931 ed. 3.4.73 snighdāṅgaḥ sthirasuvibhaktacārugātro lakṣmīvān jaladamṛdaṅgasiṃhaghoṣaḥ | suptaḥ san sakamalahaṃsacakravākān sampaśyed api ca jalāśrayān manojñāṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁śuklākṣaḥ A₁₉₃₁sthirakuṭilāli(ti)nīlakeśo A₁₉₃₁saṃpaśyedapi A₁₉₃₁jalāśayān A₁₉₃₁manojñān ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add raktāntanetraḥ suvibhaktagātraḥ snigdhacchaviḥ sattvaguṇopapannaḥ || kleśakṣamo mānayitā gurūṇāṃ jñeyo balāsaprakṛtirmanuṣyaḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.4.75 1931 ed. śā.4.75 dṛḍhaśāstramatiḥ sthiramitramanaḥ parigaṇya cirāc ca dadāti vahuḥ pariniṣṭatavākyapadaḥ satataṃ gurumānakaraś ca kaphaprakṛtiḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°tradhanaḥ A₁₉₃₁prada° A₁₉₃₁bahu || A₁₉₃₁pariniścita° A₁₉₃₁bhavetsa A₁₉₃₁add sadā ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add brahmarudrendravaruṇaiḥ siṃhāśvagajagovṛṣaiḥ || tārkṣyahaṃsasamānūkāḥ śleṣmaprakṛtayo narāḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.4.77 dṛśyate prakṛtau rūpaṃ yadā doṣadvayasya tu ||
saṃsarggan tam vijānīyāt saṃsarggas trividhaś cayaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add dvayor vā tisṛṇāṃ vā'pi A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁prakṛtīnāṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁lakṣaṇaiḥ || Hsaṃsarggantam A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁jñātvā A₁₉₃₁saṃsargajā A₁₉₃₁vaidyaḥ A₁₉₃₁prakṛtīrabhinirdiśet ||
1931 ed. 3.4.78 prakopo vānyato bhāvo kṣayo vā nopajāyate |
prakṛtīnāṃ svabhāvena jñāyante tu gatāyuṣaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁vā'nyabhāvo vā A₁₉₃₁jāyate
1931 ed. 3.4.79 viṣajāto yathā kīṭo viṣeṇa na vipadyate |
tadvat prakṛtibhir ddehas taj jātatvān na vādhate ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add na A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁tadvatprakṛtayo A₁₉₃₁martyaṃ A₁₉₃₁śaknuvanti A₁₉₃₁bādhitum ||
1931 ed. 3.4.80 prakṛtir iha narāṇāṃ bhautikī kecid āhuḥ
pavanadahanatoyaiḥ kīrttitās tās tu tisraḥ |
sthiravipulaśarīraḥ pārthivaś cet kṣamāvān
śucir atha cirajīvī nābhasaḥ khair mmahadbhiḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁prakṛtimiha A₁₉₃₁bhautikīṃ A₁₉₃₁kecidāhuḥ A₁₉₃₁, Hkīrtitāstāskīrttitāstās A₁₉₃₁ca A₁₉₃₁, Hśuciratha A₁₉₃₁khairmahadbhiḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.4.81 śaucamāstikyam ābhyāso vedeṣu gurupūjanaṃ |
priyātithitvamijyā ca vrahmakāyasya lakṣaṇam ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°stikyamabhyāso A₁₉₃₁brahma°
1931 ed. 3.4.82 sauryam ājñā mahābhāgyaṃ satataṃ śāstravuddhitā |
bhṛtyānāṃ bharaṇañ caiva māhendraṃ kāyalakṣaṇaṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add māhātmyaṃ A₁₉₃₁śauryamājñā A₁₉₃₁ca A₁₉₃₁śāstrabuddhitā || A₁₉₃₁cāpi
1931 ed. 3.4.83 sahiṣṇutatā śītasevā paiṅgākhyaṃ hari keśatā |
priyodakatvañ ca tathā vāruṇaṅ kāyalakṣaṇaṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add śītasevā A₁₉₃₁sahiṣṇutvaṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁paiṅgalyaṃ A₁₉₃₁harike° A₁₉₃₁priyavāditvamityetaddāruṇaṃ
1931 ed. 3.4.84 madhyasthatā sahiṣṇutvam arthasyāgamasañcayau |
mahāprasavaśaktiś ca kauveraṃ kāyalakṣaṇam ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁sahiṣṇutvamartha° A₁₉₃₁°śaktitvaṃ A₁₉₃₁kauberaṃ
1931 ed. 3.4.85 gandhamālyapriyatvañ ca nṛtyavāditrakāmatā |
vihāraśīlatā caiva gāndharvvaṅ kāyalakṣaṇam ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°kāmitā ||
1931 ed. 3.4.86 prāptakārī dṛḍhotthāno dhrtimān smṛtimāñ chuciḥ |
rāgadveṣabhayājñānair vvirjjito yāmyasatvavān ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁nirbhayaḥ A₁₉₃₁smṛtimān A₁₉₃₁śuciḥ || A₁₉₃₁rāgamohamadaddeṣairvarjito
1931 ed. 3.4.87 vrahmacaryavratajapaṃ homādhyayanasevinaṃ |
jñānavijñānasampannam ṛṣisatvaṃ vidur naraṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁|japavratabrahmacaryaho° A₁₉₃₁°pannamṛṣisattvaṃ A₁₉₃₁add naraṃ A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.4.88 saptaite sātvikāḥ kāyā rajasās tu nibodha me |
aiśvaryavantaṃ raudrañ ca śūraṃ caṇḍam asūyakaṃ |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁rajasāṃs A₁₉₃₁nibodhame || Hnivodhame | A₁₉₃₁caṇḍamasūyakam ||
1931 ed. 3.4.89 ekāśinaṃ tvaupadhikam āsuraṃ satvamīdṛśaṃ ||
ekāntagrāhitā raudryam asūyādharmma vākyatā |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁caudarikamāsuraṃ A₁₉₃₁tīkṣṇamāyāsinaṃ A₁₉₃₁bhīruṃ A₁₉₃₁caṇḍaṃ A₁₉₃₁māyānvitaṃ tathā ||
1931 ed. 3.4.92 bhṛśamātmastavaś cāpi rākṣasaṃ kāyalakṣaṇaṃ ||
utsṛṣṭācāratā raukṣṇyaṃ sāhasapriyatā tathā ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁bhṛśam ātma° A₁₉₃₁ucchiṣṭāhāratā A₁₉₃₁taikṣṇyaṃ
1931 ed. 3.4.93 strīlaulupatvaṃ nairllajjyaṃ paiśāco guṇasaṃgrahaḥ ||
tīkṣṇam āyāsavakulaṃ krodhanaṃ satvabhīrukaṃ |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁strīlolu° A₁₉₃₁paiśācaṃ A₁₉₃₁kāyalakṣaṇam || A₁₉₃₁asaṃvibhāgam alasaṃ A₁₉₃₁duḥkhaśīlam A₁₉₃₁asūyakam ||
1931 ed. 3.4.90 vihārāhāra capalaṃ sarppasatvam vidur nnaraṃ ||
asamvibhāgam alasan duḥśīlamasūcakam |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁vihārācāraca° A₁₉₃₁vidurnaram || A₁₉₃₁pravṛddhakāmasevī A₁₉₃₁cāpyajasrāhāra A₁₉₃₁eva ca ||
1931 ed. 3.4.94 laulupañ cāpy adātāraṃ pretasatvam vidur nnaram ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁lolupaṃ A₁₉₃₁vidurnaram || A₁₉₃₁add ṣaḍ ete rājasāḥ kāyāḥ, tāmasāṃs tu nibodha me ||
1931 ed. 3.4.91 prabuddhakāmām asevī vā jasrāsāhāra eva ca |
amarṣaṇo navasthānaḥ śākunaṃ satvam ucyate ||
ṣaḍ ete rājasāḥ kāyās tāmasās tu nibodha me ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om H°kāmāmasevī A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁ama° A₁₉₃₁'navasthāyī A₁₉₃₁kāyalakṣaṇam || A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁ekāntagrāhitā A₁₉₃₁raudramasūyā A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁dharmabāhyatā ||
1931 ed. 3.4.95 durmmedhastvaṃ mandatā ca svapna maithunanityatā |
nirākaṣṇutā śūcā vijñeyāḥ pāśavā guṇāḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁svapne H°nity atā | A₁₉₃₁nirākariṣṇutā A₁₉₃₁caiva
1931 ed. 3.4.96 anavasthitatā maurkhyaṃ bhīrutvaṃ toyakāmatā ||
parasparābhimarṣaś ca matsyasarvvātmakā guṇāḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁salilārthitā || A₁₉₃₁°mardaś A₁₉₃₁matsyasattvasya A₁₉₃₁lakṣaṇam ||
1931 ed. 3.4.97 satvavudhāṅgahīnaḥ syād āhāre kevale rataḥ |
priyārthakāmarahitaḥ satva vānaspate sthitaḥ naraḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁ekasthānaratir A₁₉₃₁nityam A₁₉₃₁vānaspatyo A₁₉₃₁add naraḥ A₁₉₃₁sattvadharmakāmārthavarjitaḥ || A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.4.98 ity ete trividhāḥ kāyāḥ proktā vairājasādayaḥ |
vijñāya kāyaprakṛtim anurūpāṃ kriyāṃ cared iti ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁vai tāmasās A₁₉₃₁tathā || A₁₉₃₁kāyānāṃ prakṛtīrjñātvā tv A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.4.99 iti śārīraṃ caturtho dhyāyaḥ ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, H, L

[Adhyāya 5. Draft based on MS H]

1931 ed. 3.5.1 athātaḥ śarīravyākaraṇaṃ śārīram vyākhyāsyāmaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁śarīrasaṃkhyāvyā° Hśārītam
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add yathovāca bhagavān dhanvantariḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.5.3 śukraśoṇitaṅ garbhāsayastham āmaprakṛtivikārasammūrcchito garbha ity ucyate || tad acetanāva𑑎sthitam vāyur vvibhajate teja enam pacati | āpaḥ kledayati | pṛthivī saṃhanti | ākāśam vivarddhayati | evam vivarddhitaḥ sa yadā hastapādajihvāghrāṇavadanakarṇṇādibhir upetas tadā śarīram iti saṃjñāṃ labhate | tac ca ṣaḍ aṅgaṃ śākhāś catvāraḥ | madhyaṃ ṣaṣṭhaṃ śira iti ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁garbhāśayastham Hgarbhāsa ya stham A₁₉₃₁ātmaprakṛtivikārasaṃmūrcchitaṃ A₁₉₃₁taṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁vibhajati, A₁₉₃₁kledayanti, A₁₉₃₁pṛthivīsaṃ° A₁₉₃₁°ṇakarṇanitambādibhir A₁₉₃₁add aṅgair A₁₉₃₁ṣaḍaṅgaṃ---śākhāś A₁₉₃₁catasro, A₁₉₃₁add pañcamaṃ,
1931 ed. 3.5.4 ataḥ param praty aṅgāni vakṣyante | mastakodarapṛṣṭhanābhilalāṭa𑑎nāsācivukagrīvā ity ete ekaikāḥ || karṇṇanetrabhrū vā ca sagaṇḍakakṣastanavaṃkṣyaṇavṛṣaṇapārśvasphik𑑎jānukurpparavāhuprabhṛtayo dve dve viṃśatir aṅgulyaḥ srotānsi vakṣyante ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁pratyaṅgāni A₁₉₃₁vakṣyante---mastakodarapṛṣṭhanābhilalāṭanāsācibukabastigrī° A₁₉₃₁etā A₁₉₃₁°bhrūśaṅkhāṃsagaṇḍakakṣastanavṛṣaṇapārśvasphigjānubāhūruprabhṛtayo A₁₉₃₁aṅgulayaḥ, A₁₉₃₁srotāṃsi A₁₉₃₁vakṣyamāṇāni , eṣa pratyaṅgavibhāga uktaḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.5.5 ity etat praty aṅgavibhāgam uktaṃ tvayābhihitāḥ kalā dhātavo maladharoś ca ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁tasya punaḥ A₁₉₃₁saṃkhyānaṃ---tvacaḥ A₁₉₃₁add kalā dhātavo A₁₉₃₁malā A₁₉₃₁add doṣā yakṛtplīhānau A₁₉₃₁add phupphusa uṇḍuko A₁₉₃₁hṛdayamāśayā antrāṇi A₁₉₃₁vṛkkau A₁₉₃₁add srotāṃsi kaṇḍarā A₁₉₃₁add jālāni kūrcā rajjavaḥ A₁₉₃₁sevanyaḥ saṅghātāḥ A₁₉₃₁sīmantā A₁₉₃₁add asthīni A₁₉₃₁sandhayaḥ snāyavaḥ A₁₉₃₁add peśyo A₁₉₃₁add marmāṇi A₁₉₃₁sairā dhamanyo A₁₉₃₁add yogavahāni srotāṃsi
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add tvacaḥ sapta, kalāḥ sapta, āśayāḥ sapta, dhātavaḥ sapta, sapta sirāśatāni, pañca peśīśatāni, nava snāyuśatāni, trīṇyasthiśatāni, dve daśottare saṃdhiśate, saptottaraṃ marmaśataṃ, caturviṃśatirdhamanyaḥ, trayo doṣāḥ, trayo malāḥ, nava srotāṃsi,(ṣoḍaśa kaṇḍarāḥ, ṣoḍaśa jālāni, ṣaṭ kūrcāḥ, catasro rajjavaḥ, sapta sevanyaḥ, caturdaśa saṅghātāḥ, caturdaśa sīmantāḥ, dvāviṃśatiryogavahāni srotāṃsi, dvikānyantrāṇi ) ceti samāsaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add vistāro 'ta ūrdhvaṃ---tvaco 'bhihitāḥ kalā dhātavo malā doṣā yakṛtplīhānau phupphusa uṇḍuko hṛdayaṃ vṛkkau ca ||
1931 ed. 3.5.8 āsayās tu vātapittaśle𑑎ṣmāmapakvāgnisūtrāṇāṃ sapta | strīṇāṃ garbhāsayoṣṭama iti |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁āśayās A₁₉₃₁vātāśayaḥ, pittāśayaḥ, śleṣmāśayo, raktāśaya, āmāśayaḥ, pakvāśayo, mūtrāśayaḥ, A₁₉₃₁garbhāśayo 'ṣṭama iti ||
1931 ed. 3.5.9 sārddhatrivyāyāmānyantrāṇi puṃṣāṃ strīṇām arddhavyāyāmahīnāni |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁sārdhatrivyāmā° A₁₉₃₁puṃsāṃ, A₁₉₃₁strīṇāmardhavyāma°
1931 ed. 3.5.10 śravaṇanayanavadanaghrāṇagudameḍhrāṇi nava srotānsi narāṇām vahir mmukhāni | tāny eva strīṇām aparāṇi ca trīṇi | dve stanayor aparam adhastād raktavāhi ca |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁śravaṇanava° A₁₉₃₁srotāṃsi A₁₉₃₁bahirmukhāni, A₁₉₃₁etānyeva A₁₉₃₁strīṇāmapa° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁adhastādraktavahaṃ
1931 ed. 3.5.11 ṣoḍaśa kaṇḍarās tāsāñ catasraḥ pādayos tāvanta eva hasta𑑎grīvāpṛṣṭheṣu | tatra hastapādagatānāṅ kaṇḍarāṇāṃ nava nava prarohā grīvāhṛdayanivandhanīnām meḍhraśoṇipṛṣṭhanivandhanīnāmadhogatānām nita mvam ūruvandhotkapiṇdīnāñ ca
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁kaṇḍarāḥ---tāsāṃ A₁₉₃₁tāvatyo A₁₉₃₁nakhā A₁₉₃₁(agra)pra° A₁₉₃₁°-nibandhinīnāmadhobhāgagatānāṃ A₁₉₃₁meḍhraṃ, śroṇipṛṣṭhanibandhinīnāmadhobhāgaga° A₁₉₃₁bimbaṃ , A₁₉₃₁mūrdhoruvakṣo 'sapiṇḍādīnāṃ
1931 ed. 3.5.12 māṃsasirāsnā yvasthidhamannījālāni praty ekaṃ catvāri tāni maṇivandhanagulphasaṃśritāni | yair vagākṣitam idaṃ śarītaṃ |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°snāyvasthijālāni A₁₉₃₁pratyekaṃ A₁₉₃₁add catvāri, A₁₉₃₁maṇibandhagu° A₁₉₃₁parasparanobaddhāni A₁₉₃₁add parasparasaṃśliṣṭāni parasparagavākṣitāni ceti, A₁₉₃₁yairgavākṣitamidaṃ A₁₉₃₁śarīram ||
1931 ed. 3.5.13 ṣaṭ kūrccās te hastapādagrīvāmeḍhreṣu |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°meḍheṣu; A₁₉₃₁add hastayor dvau, pādayor dvau, grīvāmeḍhrayor ekaikaḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.5.14 mahatyo mānsarajjavals catasraḥ peśīnivandhanārtham pṛṣṭhavaṃśam ubhayato dve vāhye abhyantare ca dve |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁māṃsarajjavaścatasraḥ---pṛṣṭhavaṃśamubha° A₁₉₃₁add peśīnibandhanārthaṃ A₁₉₃₁bāhye, A₁₉₃₁ābhyan°
1931 ed. 3.5.15 sapta sīmanyastatra vibhaktāḥ śirasi pañca jihvāśepasorekaikās tāḥ parihartavyāḥ śastreṇa |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁sevanyaḥ; sirasi A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁jihvāśephasorekaikā;
1931 ed. 3.5.16 caturddaśās saṃhatās teṣāṃ trayo gulphajānuvaṃkṣaṇeṣu | etenetarasakthi vāhu ca vyākhyā𑑎tau | trikaśirasorekaikaḥ |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁caturdaśāsthnāṃ A₁₉₃₁saṃghātāḥ; A₁₉₃₁bāhū
1931 ed. 3.5.17 caturddaśaiva sīmantāḥ | yair mmuktaḥ saṃhātāste khalvakadaśaikeṣāṃ |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁sīmantāḥ; te cāsthisaṅghātavadgaṇanīyāḥ, A₁₉₃₁yatastairyuktā asthisaṃghātāḥ; ye A₁₉₃₁hyuktāḥ A₁₉₃₁saṃghātāste A₁₉₃₁khalvaṣṭāda°
1931 ed. 3.5.18 triṇi ṣaṣṭyāśatānyasthām iti || vedavādinopabhāṣante | śalyatantreṣu trīṇyava śatāni | teṣāṃ saviṃśaty sthiśataṃ śākhāsu | saptadaśottaraṃ śataṃ śroṇīpārśvapṛṣṭhoras su |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁trīṇi A₁₉₃₁saṣaṣṭīnyasthiśatāni A₁₉₃₁°dino bhāṣante; A₁₉₃₁°tre tu A₁₉₃₁trīṇyeva A₁₉₃₁saviṃśamasthi° A₁₉₃₁śroṇipārśvapṛṣṭhoraḥsu, A₁₉₃₁grīvāṃ A₁₉₃₁add pratyūrdhvaṃ triṣaṣṭiḥ, evamasthnāṃ trīṇi śatāni pūryante ||
1931 ed. 3.5.19 grīvāyāṃ praty ūrddvan triṣaṣṭhir ekaikasyāṃ pādāṅgulyāṃ trīṇi𑑎 triṇi tāni pañcadaśa talakūrccagulphasaṃśritāni | daśa pā𑑎rṣṇyām ekaṃ jaṃghāyāṃ dve jānunyekam ekam ūrūbhyāṃ | triṃśad evam ekasmin sakthini bhavanti | etena itarasakthi vāhu vyākhyātau || śroṇyām pañca | teṣāṃ gudabhaganitamveṣu catvāri trikasaṃśritam ekaṃ pārśve ṣaṭtriṃśad ekasmin tāvantyeva dvitīye | pṛṣṭhe dvā𑑎triṃśad evāṣṭhāvurasi | dve akṣakasaṃjñe grīvāyāṃ nava kaṇṭanāḍyāṃ catvāti | dve hanusaṃjñe dantā triṃśan nāsāyān trīṇyekatāluni gaṇḍakarṇṇaśaṃkheṣv ekaikaṃ ṣaṭ chirasīti |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁add tu A₁₉₃₁trīṇi A₁₉₃₁pārṣṇyāmekaṃ, A₁₉₃₁ekamūrāviti, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁triṃśadevam A₁₉₃₁sakthni A₁₉₃₁eteneta° A₁₉₃₁bāhū A₁₉₃₁add ca A₁₉₃₁°nitambeṣu A₁₉₃₁°śritamekaṃ, A₁₉₃₁ṣaṭtriṃśadeka° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁add 'pyevaṃ, A₁₉₃₁om dvā° A₁₉₃₁aṣṭāvu° A₁₉₃₁aṃśaphalake , A₁₉₃₁kaṇṭhanāḍyāṃ A₁₉₃₁catvāri, A₁₉₃₁hanvoḥ, A₁₉₃₁dvātriṃ° A₁₉₃₁nāsāyāṃ A₁₉₃₁trīṇi, ekaṃ tā° A₁₉₃₁°kheṣvekaikaṃ, A₁₉₃₁śirasīti ||
1931 ed. 3.5.20 tān etān asthīni paṃcavidhāni bhavanti || tad yathā || kapālarūcakataruṇavalayanalakasaṃjñāni bhavanti | teṣāṃ jānurpparanitamvāḥ sagaṇḍutālumadhyaśiraḥ su kapālāni | daśanās tu rucakāḥ | ghrāṇakaṇṭhakarṇṇākṣikūṭeṣu taruṇāni | pādahastagrīvāpṛṣṭheṣu valayāni | bhavati cātra ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁etāni A₁₉₃₁tadyathā---kapālaruca° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁jānunitanbāṃsagaṇḍatāluśaṅkhaśiraḥsu A₁₉₃₁rucakāni, A₁₉₃₁ghrāṇakarṇagrīvākṣikoṣeṣu A₁₉₃₁pārśvapṛṣṭhoraḥsu A₁₉₃₁add śeṣāṇi A₁₉₃₁nalakasaṃjñāni || A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.5.21 yathā hi sāro vṛkṣa𑑎sya tiṣṭhaty abhyantarāśritaḥ |
evam asthīni jantūnāṃ śarīran dhriyate tu taiḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add bhavanti A₁₉₃₁cātra | abhyantaragataiḥ A₁₉₃₁sārairyathā A₁₉₃₁tiṣṭhanti A₁₉₃₁bhūruhāḥ || A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁asthisārais A₁₉₃₁tathā A₁₉₃₁dehā A₁₉₃₁dhriyante A₁₉₃₁dehināṃ A₁₉₃₁dhruvam ||
1931 ed. 3.5.22 tasmāc ciravinaṣṭe pi tvagmāṃse tu śarīriṇāṃ |
asthīni na viśyanti sāroṣa vidhīyate ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁tasmācciravinaṣṭeṣu A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁tvaṅgāṃseṣu A₁₉₃₁vinaśyanti A₁₉₃₁sārāṇy A₁₉₃₁etāni dehinām ||
1931 ed. 3.5.23 māṃsāny atra nivaddhāni sirābhiḥ snāyubhis tathā |
asthīny ālambanaṃ kṛtvā na śīryanti patanti vā ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁māṃsānyatra A₁₉₃₁nibaddhāni A₁₉₃₁asthīnyālam° A₁₉₃₁śīryante
1931 ed. 3.5.24 sandhayo dvividhāś ceṣṭāvantaḥ sthirāś ca |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add tu A₁₉₃₁dvividhāśceṣṭā°
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add śākhāsu hanvo kaṭyāṃ ca ceṣṭāvantas tu sandhayaḥ || śeṣās tu sandhayaḥ sarve vijñeyā hi sthirā budhaiḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.5.26 saṃkhyātās tu dve śate 𑑎daśottare teṣāṃ śākhā aṣṭaṣaṣṭir ekonaṣaṣṭiḥ koṣṭhe grīvā yāṃ𑑎ty urddhan tryāśītiḥ | ekaikasyān tu pādāṅgulyāṃ trayas trayaḥ | dvāvaṅguṣṭhe te caturddaśagulphajānuvaṃkṣyaṇeṣṭhekaikaḥ saptadaśaikasmin sakthini bhavanti | etena itarasakthi vāhu ca vyākhyātau || trayaḥ kaṭīkapāleṣu caturvviṃśatiḥ pṛṣṭhavaṃśe | tāvantya eva pārśvayoḥ | aṣṭāvūrasi | tāvantya eva grīvāyān tu yaḥ kaṇṭhanāṇḍyāṃ hṛdayaklomāsa nāḍīṣv aṣṭādaśatāsvevanivaddhā | dantaparimāṇā dantamūleṣv ekaikaḥ | kākalake nāsāyāñ caikkekaḥ | dvau dvauva𑑎rtmmamaṇḍala yor nnetrāśritau | gaṇḍakarṇṇaśaṃkheṣv ekaikaḥ | dvau hanusaṃdhī dvāvupariṣṭād bhuvau śaṃkhayoś ca pañca śiraḥ kapāleṣv eko mūrddhri |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁saṅkhyātas A₁₉₃₁daśottare A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁dve A₁₉₃₁add śate; A₁₉₃₁śākhāsvaṣṭa° A₁₉₃₁grīvāṃ A₁₉₃₁pratyūrdhvaṃ A₁₉₃₁tryaśītiḥ | A₁₉₃₁ekaikasyāṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁tryastrayaḥ, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°śa; jānugulphavaṅkṣaṇeṣvekaikaḥ, A₁₉₃₁add evaṃ A₁₉₃₁sakthni A₁₉₃₁eteneta° A₁₉₃₁bāhū A₁₉₃₁tāvanta A₁₉₃₁urasyāṣṭau; A₁₉₃₁tāvanta A₁₉₃₁grīvāyāṃ, A₁₉₃₁trayaḥ A₁₉₃₁kaṇṭhe, nāḍīṣu A₁₉₃₁°klomanibaddhāsvaṣṭādaśa, A₁₉₃₁°leṣu, A₁₉₃₁ekaḥ A₁₉₃₁ca, A₁₉₃₁vartmamaṇḍalajau A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁netrāśrayau, A₁₉₃₁°kheṣvekaikaḥ, A₁₉₃₁°ṣṭādbhruvoḥ A₁₉₃₁śaṅkhayośca, A₁₉₃₁śiraḥkapāleṣu, A₁₉₃₁mūrdhni ||
1931 ed. 3.5.27 ta ete saṃdhayoṣṭavidhā bhavanti | tad yathā | korodūkhalasāmudgaprataratūnasīvanī vāyasatuṇḍamaṇḍalaśaṃkhāvartāḥ | teṣām aṅgulimaṇivandhagulphajānukūrppareṣu korāḥ saṃdhayaḥ | kakṣavaṃkṣaṇadaśaneṣū dūkhalasaṃjñā | aṃsam pīṭhagudabhaganitamveṣu sā𑑎mudrāḥ | grīvāpṛṣṭhavaṃśeṣu pratarāḥ | śiraḥ kaṭīkapāleṣu tūna sīvanī saṃjñāḥ | hanvorūbhayatas tu vāyasa tuṇḍāḥ | kaṇṭhahṛdayanetravartmmaklomanāḍīṣu maṇḍalasaṃjñāḥ | srotaśṛṃgāṭakeṣu śaṃkhāvartāḥ || teṣāṃ nāmabhir evākṛtayaḥ prāyeṇa vyākhyātāḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁sandhayo 'ṣṭavidhāḥ---korolūkhalasāmudgaprataratunnasevanīvā° A₁₉₃₁aṅgulimaṇibandha° A₁₉₃₁kakṣāvaṅkṣaṇadaśaneṣūlūkhalāḥ, A₁₉₃₁aṃsapīṭhagudabhaganitambeṣu A₁₉₃₁sāmudgāḥ, A₁₉₃₁°vaṃśayoḥ A₁₉₃₁śiraḥka° A₁₉₃₁tunnasevanyaḥ, A₁₉₃₁om H°ya ta A₁₉₃₁hanor ubhayatastu Hstu A₁₉₃₁vāyasatuṇḍaḥ, A₁₉₃₁°traklomanāḍīṣu A₁₉₃₁maṇḍalāḥ, A₁₉₃₁śrotraśṛṅ°
1931 ed. 3.5.28 bhavati cātra || asnthāṃ tu saṃdhayo hyete kevalaṃ parikīrti𑑎tāḥ |
peśīsnāyusirāṇān tu sandhisaṃkhyān na vidyate ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁asthnāṃ A₁₉₃₁kevalāḥ A₁₉₃₁°rāṇāṃ A₁₉₃₁°khyā
1931 ed. 3.5.29 nava snāyu śatāni bhavanti | teṣāṃ śā𑑎khāsu ṣaṭ chatāni | dve śate triṃśac ca koṣṭhe grīvāyāṃ pratyurdhvaṃ saptatiḥ | ekaikasyāṃ pādāṅgulyāṃ ṣaṭnicitāni triṃśac ca | tāvatya eva talakūrccagulpheṣu tāvatya eva jaṃghāyāṃ | daśa jānuni | catvāriṃśadūrvvāḥ | daśavaṃkṣaṇe | pañcāśat chatam evam ekasmin sakchini bhavanti | etena itarasakthi vahū vyākhyātau || ṣaṣṭiḥ kaṭyāḥ pṛṣṭhetvaśītiḥ | pārśvayoḥ | ṣaṣṭiḥ | urasi triṃśat | ṣaṭtriṃśad grīvāyāṃ | mūrddhri catustriṃśat | eva navasnāyuśatāni vyākhyātāni bhavanti | mahāsnāyuṣu kaṇḍareti saṃjñā ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁snāyuśa° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁tāsāṃ A₁₉₃₁ṣaṭśatāni, A₁₉₃₁grīvāṃ A₁₉₃₁pratyūrdhvaṃ A₁₉₃₁add tu A₁₉₃₁ṣaṭ nicitāḥ, A₁₉₃₁tāstriṃśat, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°dūrau, A₁₉₃₁daśa vaṅ° A₁₉₃₁śatamadhyardhamevam A₁₉₃₁sakthni A₁₉₃₁eteneta° A₁₉₃₁bāhū A₁₉₃₁add ca A₁₉₃₁kaṭyāṃ, A₁₉₃₁pṛṣṭe 'śītiḥ, A₁₉₃₁ṣaṭtriṃśadgrīvāyāṃ, A₁₉₃₁mūrdhni A₁₉₃₁evaṃ A₁₉₃₁nava snā° A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.5.30 bhavanti cātra ślokāḥ || caturvvidhāni snāyūni nāsateṣān nibodha me |
pratānavanti vṛtāni𑑎 susirāṇi pṛthūni ca ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁snāyūścaturvidhā A₁₉₃₁add vidyāttās A₁₉₃₁tu A₁₉₃₁sarvā A₁₉₃₁pratānavatyo A₁₉₃₁vṛttāś A₁₉₃₁ca A₁₉₃₁pṛthvyaś ca śuṣirās A₁₉₃₁tathā ||
1931 ed. 3.5.31 pratānavanti śākhāsu sarvvasaṃ𑑎dhiṣu cāpy atha |
vṛtāni kaṇḍarāḥ sarvvā vijñeyā kuśalair iha ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁pratānavatyaḥ H°𑑎cdhi ṣu A₁₉₃₁cāpyatha || A₁₉₃₁vṛttās tu A₁₉₃₁bijñeyāḥ A₁₉₃₁kuśalairiha ||
1931 ed. 3.5.32 āmapakvāsayānteṣu susirāṇi pṛthūni ca |
pārśvorasi tathā pṛṣṭhe pṛthūlāni śiras ca ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°kvāśayānteṣu A₁₉₃₁add bastau ca A₁₉₃₁śuṣirāḥ A₁₉₃₁khalu || A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁pṛthulāś ca A₁₉₃₁śirasyatha ||
1931 ed. 3.5.33 naur yathā phalakās tīrṇṇā vandhanair vahubhir yutāḥ |
bhaved bhārasahā dṛḍhasandhisamāśritāḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁nauryathā A₁₉₃₁phalakāstīrṇā A₁₉₃₁bandhanairbahubhir A₁₉₃₁bhārakṣamā A₁₉₃₁bhavedapsu A₁₉₃₁nṛyuktā susamāhitā ||
1931 ed. 3.5.34 eva, eva śarīresmin yāvantaḥ sandhayaḥ smṛtāḥ |
snāyubhir vvahubhir vvaddāstena bhārasahāḥ smṛtā ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁evam A₁₉₃₁śarīre 'smin A₁₉₃₁bahubhir A₁₉₃₁baddhāstena A₁₉₃₁bhārasahā A₁₉₃₁narāḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.5.35 na hy asthīni na peśyo vā na sirā na ca sandhayaḥ |
vyāpāditās tathā hanyur yathā snāyūni dehināṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁hanyuryathā A₁₉₃₁snāyuḥ A₁₉₃₁śarīriṇam ||
1931 ed. 3.5.36 yaḥ snāyūni vijānāni sa vāhyāsyantarāṇi ca |
sa guḍhāṃ śalyamudvarntun dehāc chakroti mānavaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁snāyūḥ A₁₉₃₁pravijānāti A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁bāhyāś cābhyantarās A₁₉₃₁tathā || A₁₉₃₁gūḍhaṃ A₁₉₃₁śalyamāhartuṃ A₁₉₃₁dehācchaknoti A₁₉₃₁dehinām ||
1931 ed. 3.5.37 pañca peśīśatāni tāsāñ ca catvāt iṃ śaktāni śākhāsu | koṣṭhe ṣaṣṭhiḥ | grīvāyāṃ pratyurddhañ catvāriṃśat || ekaikasyāṃ pādāṃgulyāṃ tisrastisrastāḥ pañcadaśa | pañcadaśaprapede pādopari | kurccasanniviṣṭās tāvantya eva | daśagulphatalayoḥ | gulphajānvontare viṃśatiḥ | pañca jānini | ūrvoddaśa | vaṃkṣaṇe daśa | śatam eka𑑎smin sakthini bhavantye na itara sakthi vāhū ca vyākhyātau || ekā meḍhra sevanyāṃ | apare dve vṛṣaśayoḥ | gude tisraḥ | sphicoś ca pañca pañca | dve vasti śira𑑎si | saptodare nābhyām ekā | pṛṣṭhorddhasaṃniviṣṭāḥ pañca pañca dīrghāḥ | pārśvayor daśa | dve vakṣasi | akṣakāṃ saṃpratisamaṃtāt sapta | dve hṛdyāmāsaye | ekābhyantarataḥ koṣṭhe | grīvāyāñ ca tasra | ekaikā galakālayoḥ | dve tāluni | jihvāyāṃ ṣaṭ | dve joṣṭhayoḥ | nāsāyāṃ dve | gaṇḍayoś catasraś catasraḥ | netrayor ddha | karṇṇayor dve | catasro lalāṭe | ṣaṭ chirasīti | tāny etāni pañca peśīśatāni puṃsām bhavanti |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add bhavanti | A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁catvāri A₁₉₃₁śatāni A₁₉₃₁ṣaṭṣaṣṭiḥ, A₁₉₃₁grīvāṃ A₁₉₃₁pratyūrdhvaṃ A₁₉₃₁catustriṃśat | A₁₉₃₁add tu A₁₉₃₁daśa prapade, A₁₉₃₁kūrcasanniviṣṭāstāvatya A₁₉₃₁daśa gu° A₁₉₃₁gulphajānvantare A₁₉₃₁vañ ca A₁₉₃₁jānuni, A₁₉₃₁viṃśatirūrau, daśa A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁śatamevam A₁₉₃₁sakthni A₁₉₃₁bhavanti, A₁₉₃₁etenetarasakthi A₁₉₃₁bāhū A₁₉₃₁add tisraḥ pāyau, A₁₉₃₁meḍhre, A₁₉₃₁cāparā, A₁₉₃₁vṛṣaṇayoḥ, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁bastiśi° A₁₉₃₁pañcodare, A₁₉₃₁nābhyāmekā, A₁₉₃₁pṛṣṭhordhvasan° A₁₉₃₁add ṣaṭ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁akṣakāṃsau prati sa° A₁₉₃₁hṛdayāmāśayayoḥ, A₁₉₃₁add ṣaṭ A₁₉₃₁yakṛtplīhoṇḍukeṣu; A₁₉₃₁catasraḥ, aṣṭau hanvoḥ, A₁₉₃₁kākalakagalayoḥ, A₁₉₃₁add ekā A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁oṣṭhayor A₁₉₃₁add dve, A₁₉₃₁add dve A₁₉₃₁netrayoḥ, A₁₉₃₁gaṇḍayoścatasraḥ, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁ekā A₁₉₃₁śira° A₁₉₃₁evam A₁₉₃₁om
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add bhavati cātra | sirāsnāyvasthiparvāṇi sandhayaś ca śarīriṇām || peśībhiḥ saṃvṛtānyatra balavanti bhavantyataḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.5.39 strīṇāñ caturddaśāsyadhikā | daśa tāsāṃ stanayor ekaikasmin pañca pañca | yauvane tāsāṃ parivṛddhir bhavati | apatyapathe catasras tāsāṃ dve prasṛte bhyantarataḥ | dve mukhāsri𑑎te ca | vṛtte dve garbham āśritāḥ | tisraḥ śukrār bhavaḥ prave𑑎śinyaḥ | tisra eva garbhaśayyāyāṃ yatra garbhas tiṣṭhati |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add tu A₁₉₃₁viṃśatiradhikā | A₁₉₃₁pañceti, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁catasraḥ---tāsāṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁mukhāśrite A₁₉₃₁add bāhye Hgarvbham A₁₉₃₁garbhacchidrasaṃśritāstisraḥ, A₁₉₃₁śukrārtavapraveśinyastisra A₁₉₃₁add pittakvāśayayor madhye Hgarvbhaśa° A₁₉₃₁°yyā, Hgarvbhas A₁₉₃₁garbhastiṣṭhati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add tāsāṃ bahalapelavasthūlāṇupṛthuvṛttahrasvadīrghāsthiramṛduślakṣṇakarkaśabhāvāḥ sandhyasthisirāsnāyupracchādakā yathāpradeśaṃ svabhāvata eva bhavanti ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add bhavati cātra | puṃsāṃ peśyaḥ purastādyāḥ proktā lakṣaṇamuṣkajāḥ || strīṇāmāvṛtya tiṣṭhanti phalamantargataṃ hi tāḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.5.42 marmmasirādhamanīsrotasām anyatra𑑎 vibhāgaḥ |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°tasāmanyatra A₁₉₃₁pravibhāgaḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.5.43 bhavati cātra || śaṃkhanābhyo kṛtir yonis trir āvartā prakīrtitā |
tasyās tṛtīye tv āvarte garbhaśayyā pratiṣṭhitā ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁śaṅkhanābhyākṛtiryonistryāvartā A₁₉₃₁add A₁₉₃₁tasyāstṛtīye A₁₉₃₁tvāvarte Hgarvbhaśayyā
1931 ed. 3.5.44 yathā rohitamatsya𑑎sya mukham bhavati rūpataḥ |
tat sthānañ ca yathārūpaṃ garbhaśayyām vidurvvudhā ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁tatsaṃsthānāṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁tathārūpāṃ Hgarvbhaśacyyām A₁₉₃₁vidurbudhāḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.5.45 ābhugno 'bhimukhaḥ śete garvbho garvbhāśaye striyāḥ |
sa yoniṃ yāti śirasā svabhāvāt prasavam prati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁garbho A₁₉₃₁garbhāśaye A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁add yāti
1931 ed. 3.5.46 tvak paryantasya dehasya yo yam aṅgaviniścayaḥ |
śalyajñānādṛte nāyaṃ varṇyate ṅgeṣu keṣucit ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁tvakparyan° A₁₉₃₁'yamaṅga° A₁₉₃₁naiśa
1931 ed. 3.5.47 tasyānnisaṃśayaṃ jñānaṃ śalya harttābhi vāñcchatā |
dhāvayitvā mṛtaṃ samyagdraṣṭavyoṅgaviniścayaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁tasmānniḥsaṃ° A₁₉₃₁add hartrā A₁₉₃₁śalyasya A₁₉₃₁śodhayitvā A₁₉₃₁samyagdraṣṭavyayo 'ṅga°
1931 ed. 3.5.48 pratyakṣato hi yad dṛṣṭaṃ śāstradṛṣṭañ ca yad bhavet |
samāgatan tadubhayam bhūyo jñānam vivarddhayet ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁yaddṛṣṭaṃ A₁₉₃₁yadbhavet || A₁₉₃₁samāsatastadu° A₁₉₃₁jñānavivardhanam ||
1931 ed. 3.5.49 tasmāt samastagātram avihatam adīrghavyādhipīḍitaṃ puruṣam apahṛtyāpagāyāṃ | vivaddhaṃ muñjavalvajaiḥ pañjarastamprakāśe deśe kothayet | samyak prakuthitañ coddhṛtyāya tad ehaṃ𑑎 kṛtvo śīratṛṇeveṣu kurccādīnām anyatamena śanaiḥ śanair eva ghṛṣyatvagādīn sarvvaān eva vāhyābhyanta𑑎rāna ṅgapratyaṅgaviśeṣān yathoktān lakṣayec cakṣuṣā ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°gātramaviṣopahatamadīrghavyādhipīḍitamavarṣaśatikaṃ A₁₉₃₁niḥsṛṣṭāntrapurīṣaṃ A₁₉₃₁puruṣamavahantyāmāpa° A₁₉₃₁nibaddhaṃ A₁₉₃₁add pañjarasthaṃ A₁₉₃₁muñjavalkalakuśaśaṇādīnāmanyatamenāveṣṭitāṅgapratyaṅgamapra° A₁₉₃₁samyakpraku° A₁₉₃₁coddhṛtya A₁₉₃₁tato A₁₉₃₁dehaṃ A₁₉₃₁saptarātrāduśīrabālaveṇuvalkalakūrcānām A₁₉₃₁śanairavagharṣayaṃstvagā° A₁₉₃₁sarvāneva A₁₉₃₁bāhyābhyantarānaṅga° A₁₉₃₁lakṣayeccakṣuṣā ||
1931 ed. 3.5.50 ślokau || na śakyañ cakṣuṣā draṣṭaṃ saukṣmyāsaukṣyataraṃ viduḥ |
dṛśyate jñānacakṣurbhis tapaś ca kṣurvbhis tapaś cakṣurvbhir evā |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add cātra bhavataḥ |) A₁₉₃₁śakyaś A₁₉₃₁draṣṭuṃ A₁₉₃₁add dehe A₁₉₃₁sūkṣmatamo A₁₉₃₁vibhuḥ | A₁₉₃₁tapaścakṣurbhir A₁₉₃₁eva A₁₉₃₁ca ||
1931 ed. 3.5.51 śarīre cāpi śāstre ca dṛṣṭārthas tu viśāradaḥ |
dṛṣṭaśrutābhyāṃ sandehaṃ vyaporabhate kriyām iti || ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁caiva A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁syādviśā° A₁₉₃₁°tābhayāṃ A₁₉₃₁sandehamavāpohyācaret A₁₉₃₁kriyāḥ || A₁₉₃₁om
iti śārīre pañcamo dhyāyaḥ || ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, H, L

[Adhyāya 6. Draft based on MS H]

1931 ed. 3.6.1 athātaḥ pra𑑎tyekamarmmanirddeśaṃ śārīram vyākhyāsyāmaḥ ||
K, N, L
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add yathovāca bhagavān dhanvantariḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.6.3 saptottaram marmmaśataṃ | tāni pañcavidhāni marmmāṇi bhavanti | tad yathā | mānsamarmmāṇi | śirāmarmmāṇi | snāyumarmmāṇi, asthimarmmāṇi | sandhimarmmāṇi | na khalu māṃsaśirāsnāyvasthisandhivyatirekeṇānyāni marmmāṇi bhavanti || yasmān nopalabhyante ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add marmāṇi A₁₉₃₁pañcātmakāni A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁yathā---māṃsama° A₁₉₃₁sirā° A₁₉₃₁add ceti; A₁₉₃₁māṃsasirā°
1931 ed. 3.6.4 tatraikādaśa māṃsamarmmāṇi, ekacatvāriṃśac chirāmarmmāṇi | saptāviṃśatiḥ snāyumarmmāṇi | aṣṭāv asthimarmmāṇi | viṃśatiḥ sandhimarmmāṇīti | tad etat saptottaram marmmaśataṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°śat sirāmarmāṇi, H°śac chirāmarmmāṇi | A₁₉₃₁saptaviṃ° A₁₉₃₁°rmāṇi ceti |
1931 ed. 3.6.5 eṣām ekādaśaikasmin sakthini bhavanti | etenetarasakthi bāhū ca vyākhyātau ca bhavataḥ | udarorasor ddvā𑑎daśa | caturddaśa pṛṣṭhe | grīvāyām pratyūrddhvaṃ saptatriṃśat |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁teṣām A₁₉₃₁sakthni A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁grīvāṃ
1931 ed. 3.6.6 tatra sakthimarmmāṇi | kṣipratalahṛdayakurccakū𑑎rccaśirogulphendravastijānuścāṇyūrvīlohitākṣāṇi ciṭipañ ceti | etenetaratsakthibāhū vyākhyātau || udarorasos tu marmmāṇy anuvyākhyāsyāmaḥ || gudo vastir nnābhir hṛdayaṃ stanamūle stanalohite apālāye apastambhe ce𑑎ti || pṛṣṭhamarmmāṇi tu | kaṭīkataruṇa | kukundaranitambe pārśvasandhibṛhatyaṃsaphalakrakanyāsau ce𑑎ti || jatruṇa ūrdhvaṃ catasro dhamanyo ṣṭau mātṛkāḥ | dve kṛkāṭike | dve vidhure | dve phaṇe | dvāv apāṅgau | dvau śaṃkhau | dvāv āvartau | dvāv utkṣepau | ekā sthapaṇī | pañca sīmantāḥ | catvāri śṛṃgāṭakānyeko 'dhipatir iti ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁kṣipratalahṛdayakūrcakūrcaśirogulphendrabastijānvāṇyū° A₁₉₃₁viṭapaṃ A₁₉₃₁°kthi A₁₉₃₁vyākhyātam | A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁gudabastinābhihṛdayastanamūla-stanarohitāpalāpānyapastambhau A₁₉₃₁°ṇakukundaranitambapārśvasandhibṛhatyaṃsaphalakānyaṃsau A₁₉₃₁add ceti | bāhumarmāṇi tu kṣipratalahṛdayakūrcakūrcaśiromaṇibandhendrabastikūrparāṇyūrvīlohitākṣaṇi kakṣadharaṃ A₁₉₃₁add etenetaro bāhurvyākhyātaḥ | A₁₉₃₁add (marmāṇi) A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁add dvau śaṅkhāv A₁₉₃₁sthapanī A₁₉₃₁'dhipatiriti ||
1931 ed. 3.6.7 tatra talahṛdayendravastigudastanarohitāni | māṃsamarmmāṇi | nīladhamanī | mātṛkā sirāḥ śṛṅgāṭakāpāṅgasthapaṇīphaṇastanamūlāpalāpāpastambhahṛdayanābhipārśvasandhibṛhatīlohitākṣāṇy ūrvvyās sirāmarmmāṇi | ciṭipakakṣadharakurccaḥ | kūrccaśirovastikukṣāṇy ansavidhuro𑑎tkṣepāḥ snāyumarmmāṇi | kaṭīkataruṇanitambānsaphala𑑎kaśaṃkhāny asthimarmmāṇi | jānukurpparasīmantā'dhipatigulphamaṇibandhakukundarāvarttakṛkāṭikāś ceti | sandhimarmmāṇi ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁talahṛdayendrabasti° A₁₉₃₁°nīmātṛkāśṛṅgāṭakāpāṅgasthapanīphaṇastanamūlāpalāpāpastambhahṛdayanābhipārśvasandhibṛhatīlohitākṣorvyaḥ A₁₉₃₁āṇīviṭapakakṣadharakūrcakūrcaśirobastikṣiprāṃsavi° A₁₉₃₁°tambāṃsaphalakaśaṅkhāstvasthimarmāṇi, A₁₉₃₁jānukūrparasīmantādhipatigulphamaṇibandhakukundarānarta°
1931 ed. 3.6.8 tāny etāni marmmāṇi pañcavidhāni bhavanti || tad yathā | sadyaḥprāṇaharāṇi | kālāntaraprāṇaharāṇi | viśalyaghnāni | vaikalyakarāṇi | rujākarāṇi ceti || tatra sadyaḥprāṇaharāṇy ekonaviṃśatiḥ | kālāntaraprāṇaharāṇi trayastriṃśat | viśalyaghnāni trīṇi | catuścatvāriṃśad vaikalyakarāṇi | aṣṭau rujākarāṇīti ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁pañcavikalpāni A₁₉₃₁add marmāṇi A₁₉₃₁yathā---sa° A₁₉₃₁°rāṇīti | A₁₉₃₁add trīṇi A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.6.9 bhavanti cātra ||
śṛṅgāṭakāny adhipatiḥ śaṃkhau kaṇṭhasirā gudaḥ |
hṛdvasti saha vai nābhyāṃ ghnanti sadyo hatāni tu ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁gudam || A₁₉₃₁hṛdayaṃ A₁₉₃₁bastinābhī A₁₉₃₁add ca
1931 ed. 3.6.10 vakṣomarmmāṇi sīmantās talaḥ kṣiprendrabastayaḥ |
kaṭīkataruṇe sandhī pārśvajo bṛhatī ca ye ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁sīmantatalakṣi° A₁₉₃₁pārśvajau A₁₉₃₁yā ||
1931 ed. 3.6.11 nitambāv iti caitāni kālāntaraharāṇi tu |
utkṣepau sthapaṇī caiva, viśalyaghnāni nirddiśet ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁sthapanī
1931 ed. 3.6.12 lohitākṣaś ca jānūrvvīkurccāciṭipakurpparā |
kukundare kakṣadhare vidhure sakṛkāṭike ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁lohitākṣāṇi A₁₉₃₁jānūrvīkūrcaniṭapakūrparāḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.6.13 ansānsaphalakāpāṅge, nīle manye phaṇe tathā |
vaikalyakaraṇāny āhu,r āvarttau dvau tathaiva ca ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁aṃsāṃsaphalakāpāṅgā
1931 ed. 3.6.14 gulphau dvau maṇibandhau dvau dve dve kurccaśirāṃsi ca |
rujākarāṇi jānīyād aṣṭāv etāni buddhimān ||
pañcoktāni vikalpāni marmmaṇāṃ karmmaṇām pṛthak ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁kūrca° A₁₉₃₁kṣiprāṇi A₁₉₃₁viddhamātrāṇi A₁₉₃₁ghnanti A₁₉₃₁kālāntareṇa A₁₉₃₁ca ||
1931 ed. 3.6.15 marmmāṇi nāma mānsasirāsnāyvasthisandhisannipātāḥ | teṣu svabhāvata eva prāṇās tiṣṭhanti | marmmasv abhihatās tām̐s tān bhāvān āpadyante ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁māṃsasi° A₁₉₃₁add viśeṣeṇa A₁₉₃₁add tasmān A₁₉₃₁tāṃs A₁₉₃₁bhāvan
1931 ed. 3.6.16 tatra sadyaḥprāṇaharāṇi | āgneyāni | agniguṇeṣu kṣīṇeṣv āyuḥ kṣapayanti | viśalyaghnāni vāyavīyāni śastramukhāvaruddho yāvad atra vāyus tiṣṭhati tāvaj jīvaty uddhṛtamātre tu śalye | marmmasthānāśrayo vāyur nniṣkrāmati | tasmāt saśalyo jīvaty uddhṛtaśalyo mriyate | vaika𑑎lyakarāṇi | saumyāni | somo hi śaityāt sthiratvāc ca prāṇāvalambanaṃ karoti | rujākarāṇi | agnimārutabhūyiṣṭhāni viśeṣeṇa tau rujākarau pāñcabhautikīñ ca rujām apare tv āhuḥ |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°rāṇyāgneyāni, A₁₉₃₁°ṇeṣvāśu A₁₉₃₁kṣīṇeṣu A₁₉₃₁add kṣapayanti; kālāntaraprāṇaharāṇi A₁₉₃₁add saumyāgneyāni, A₁₉₃₁agniguṇeṣvāśu kṣīṇeṣu krameṇa ca somaguṇeṣu kālāntareṇa A₁₉₃₁viśalyaprāṇaharāṇi A₁₉₃₁vāyvyāni, A₁₉₃₁śalyamu° A₁₉₃₁antarvāyus A₁₉₃₁°nāśrito A₁₉₃₁vāyurniṣkrā° A₁₉₃₁add (pākātpatitaśalyo vā jīvati) ; A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁sthiratvāc chaityāc A₁₉₃₁trāṇā° A₁₉₃₁rujākarāṇyagnivāyuguṇabhū° A₁₉₃₁viśeṣataśca A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁add eke ||
1931 ed. 3.6.17 kecid āhur mmānsādīnāṃ samastānāṃ samṛddhānāñ ca samavāyāt | sadyaḥprāṇaharāṇi | ekahīnānām alpānāñ ca samavāyakālāntaraprāṇaharāṇi | dvihīnānāṃ tu viśalyaprāṇaharāṇi | trihīnānān tu vaiguṇyakarāṇi | ekasminn eva rujākarāṇīti || yataś caivamato sthimarmmasv api kṣateṣu śoṇitāgamanam bhavati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁māṃsādīnāṃ A₁₉₃₁add pañcānāmapi A₁₉₃₁vivṛddhānāṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁vā kā° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁trihīnānāṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁vaikalyaka° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁naivaṃ, yato A₁₉₃₁'sthimarmasvapyabhihateṣu A₁₉₃₁śoṇitāamanaṃ
1931 ed. 3.6.18 bhavanti cātra ||
caturvvidhā yās tu sirāḥ śarīre, prāyeṇa tā marmmasu sanniviṣṭāḥ |
snāyvasthimāṃsāni tathaiva sandhī, santarppayantyopacayanti dehaṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁sandhīn A₁₉₃₁santarpya A₁₉₃₁add pratipālayanti ||
1931 ed. 3.6.19 tataḥ kṣate marmmaṇi tāḥ pravṛddhaḥ samantato vāyur abhistṛṇoti | vivarddhamānas tu sa mā𑑎tariśvā rujāḥ sutīvrāḥ pratanoti kāye ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁kṣte A₁₉₃₁rujaḥ
1931 ed. 3.6.20 rujābhibhūtas tu tataḥ śarīraṃ, pralīyate naśyati cāsya saṃjñā ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°bhūtaṃ A₁₉₃₁add ato hi śalyaṃ vinihartumicchanmarmāṇi yatnena parīkṣya karṣet ||
1931 ed. 3.6.21 etena śeṣaṃ vyākhyātaṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁etenaśeṣaṃ
1931 ed. 3.6.22 tatra sadyaḥprāṇaharam ante viddhaṃ kālāntareṇa mārayati | kālāntaraprāṇahara𑑎m ante viddhaṃ vaikalyakaram bhavati | viśalyaghnañ ca vaikalyakaram bhavati | nānātīvrāṃ𑑎 vedanāñ janayaṃti | vaikalyakaraṃ kālāntareṇa kleśayati | rujām vā karoti rujākaraṃ cālpavedanāṃ karoti |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁vaikalyamāpādayati A₁₉₃₁viśalyaprāṇaharaṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁ca, A₁₉₃₁kālāntaraṃ A₁₉₃₁ca A₁₉₃₁rujākaramatīvravedanaṃ A₁₉₃₁bhavati ||
1931 ed. 3.6.23 tatra sadyaḥprāṇaharāṇi saptarātrābhyantarāt mārayanti | kālānta𑑎raprāṇaharāṇi pakṣāt māsād vā | teṣv api tu kṣiprāṇi kadācid āśu mārayanti | viśalyaprāṇaharāṇi vaikalyakarāṇi ca kadācid atyabhihatāni mārayanti ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁mārayati, A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.6.24 uta ūrdhvaṃ sakthimarmmāṇy anuvyākhyāsyāmaḥ || tatra pādasyāṅguṣṭhāṅgulyor mmadhye kṣipraṃ nāma marma ... madhyamāṅgulim anupūrvveṇa madhye pādatalasya talahṛdayan nāma marmma tatra rujāyām maraṇaṃ | kṣipratyopariṣṭād aṅgulam ubhayataḥ kūrcco nāma | ...ṇavepane bhavataḥ | gulphasandher adhaḥ kūrccaśiro nāma tatra rujā𑑎śophau bhavataḥ || pādajaṃghayos tu sandhāne gulpho nāma tatra rukastabdhasakthitā ca kuṇatā vā... pārṣṇim prati jaṃghāmadhyendravastir nnāma marmma tatra śoṇitakṣa𑑎ye maraṇaṃ | jaṃghorvvoḥ sandhāne jānur nnāma tatra khañjatā bhavati | jānos tryaṅgulād ūrddhva...ṇir nnāma marmma tatra śophābhivṛddhiḥ stabdhasakthitā ca | ūrūma𑑎dhye ūrvvī nāma marmma tatra śoṇitakṣayāt sakthiśoṣaḥ | ūrvvyās tūrdhvam adho vaṃkṣaṇasa...le lohitākṣan nāma marmma tatra śoṇitakṣaye maraṇam pakṣāghāto vā || vaṃkṣaṇavṛṣaṇayor antare ciṭipan nāma marmma tatra sāṃḍhyam alpaśukratā ca bhavati | evam etāny ekādaśa sakthimarmmāṇi vyākhyātāni | etenetarasakthi bāhū ca vyākhyātāḥ || viśeṣatas tu yāni sakthini gulphajānuvaṃkṣaṇaciṭipāni tāni bāhau maṇibandhakurpparakakṣadharāṇi bhavanti | yathā ca pādajaṃghayos tu sandhau gulphau nāma marmma | evaṃ hastatalaprakoṣṭhayoḥ sandhau maṇibandho𑑎 nāma marmma | yathā ca jaṃghorvvoḥ sandhāne jānu nāma marmma | evaṃ prahastabāhvoḥ sandhāne kurpparo nāma marmma | yathā ca vaṃkṣaṇavṛṣaṇayor mmadhye ciṭipan nāma marmma | evam akṣakakṣayor mmadhye kakṣadharo nāma marmma | tatra viddheṣu ta evopadravā bhavanti | viśeṣatas tu maṇibandhe kuṇṭhatā | kurppare pakṣāghātaḥ | kuṇitvaṃ kakṣadhare𑑎 ceti | evam etāni catuścatvāriṃśac chākhāmarmmāṇi vyākhyātā𑑎ni bhavanti ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁pratyekaśo marmasthānāni A₁₉₃₁vyākhyāsyāmaḥ---tatra A₁₉₃₁add tatra viddhasyākṣepakeṇa maraṇaṃ; A₁₉₃₁°gulīm A₁₉₃₁anupūrvaṇa A₁₉₃₁°dayaṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁tatrāpi A₁₉₃₁rujābhir A₁₉₃₁°ṣṭādubhayataḥ A₁₉₃₁add tatra pādasya A₁₉₃₁bhramaṇa° A₁₉₃₁adha ubhayataḥ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁rujaḥ stabdhapādatā A₁₉₃₁khañjatā Hjaṃghāmadhye ndra° A₁₉₃₁jaṅghāmadhye indribastir A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°yeṇa A₁₉₃₁jānu A₁₉₃₁add jānuna ūrdhvam A₁₉₃₁ubhayatas A₁₉₃₁tryaṅgulamāṇī A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁ūrumadhye A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁ūrvyā A₁₉₃₁ūrdhvam A₁₉₃₁vaṅkṣaṇasaṃdher-ūrumūle A₁₉₃₁lohitākṣaṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁lohitakṣayeṇa A₁₉₃₁add sakthiśoṣo A₁₉₃₁niṭapaṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁ṣāṇḍhyam A₁₉₃₁ A₁₉₃₁vyākhyātau | A₁₉₃₁sakthni A₁₉₃₁°nuviṭapāni A₁₉₃₁maṇibandhakūrpa° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁antare A₁₉₃₁viṭapamevaṃ A₁₉₃₁vakṣaḥka° A₁₉₃₁kakṣadharaṃ, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁tasmin A₁₉₃₁viddhe A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁kūrparākhye A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁kuṇiḥ, A₁₉₃₁pakṣāghātaḥ | A₁₉₃₁°śacchākhāsu marmāṇi H°śac chākhāmarmmāṇi A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.6.25 ata ūrdhvam udarorasor dvādaśa marmmāṇy anuvyākhyāsyāmaḥ || tatra vātavarcconiḥsaraṇī sthūlāntrapratibaddham mahāgudo nāma | tatra sadyo maraṇaṃ | alpamāṃsaśoṇitam abhyantarataḥ | kaṭyāmutrāsayayor vastir nnāma marmma | tatrāpi sadyo maraṇaṃ | aśmarīvraṇād ṛte tatrāpy ubhayato viddhe maraṇam ekato bhinne mūtrāsrāvī vraṇo bhavati | sa tu yatnenopakrānto rohati || pakvāmāśayayor mmadhye śirāprabhāvo nābhir nnāma marmma tatrāpi sadyo maraṇaṃ | stanayor mmadhyam adhiṣṭhāyorasi āmāśayadvāraṃ sattvarajastamasām adhiṣṭhānaṃ hṛdayan nāma marmma tatrāpi sadyo maraṇaṃ | stanayor adhastād dvyaṅgulam ubhayataḥ stanamūle nāma marmaṇī | tatra kaphapūrṇṇakoṣṭhatayā maraṇaṃ | stanacūcukayor ūrddhve stanarohite nāma marmmaṇī | tatra raktapūrṇṇakoṣṭhatayā kāsaśvāsābhyām maraṇaṃ | aṃsakūṭayor adha𑑎stāt pārśvayor uparibhāgayor apālāpau nāma marmmaṇī | tatra pūyabhāvam āpanne śoṇite maraṇaṃ | ubhayatroraso nāḍyo vātavahe | apastambhau nāma marmmaṇī | tatra vāta𑑎pūrṇṇakoṣṭhatayā kāsaśvāsābhyām maraṇaṃ | evam etāny udarorasor dvādaśa marmmāṇi vyākhyātāni ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°rasor-marmāṇy A₁₉₃₁°rconirasanaṃ A₁₉₃₁°tivaddhaṃ A₁₉₃₁gudaṃ A₁₉₃₁add marma, A₁₉₃₁sadyoma° A₁₉₃₁°ṇito+bhyantarataḥ A₁₉₃₁kṭyāṃ mutrāśayo A₁₉₃₁bastirnāma, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁sadyomaraṃam A₁₉₃₁bhinne A₁₉₃₁na A₁₉₃₁add jāvati, A₁₉₃₁mūtrasrāvī A₁₉₃₁sirāprabhāvā A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁madhyamadhiṣṭhāyor asyāmā° A₁₉₃₁hṛdayaṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁sadya A₁₉₃₁add eva A₁₉₃₁kasaśvāsābhyāṃ A₁₉₃₁add mriyate; A₁₉₃₁ūrdhvaṃ dvaṅgulamubhayataḥ A₁₉₃₁°hitau A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁lohitapū° A₁₉₃₁ca A₁₉₃₁add mriyate; A₁₉₃₁pārśbopa° A₁₉₃₁apalāpau A₁₉₃₁tatra A₁₉₃₁raktena A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁gatena A₁₉₃₁nāḍyau A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁add ca A₁₉₃₁e am
1931 ed. 3.6.26 ata ūrdhvam pṛṣṭhamarmmāṇy anuvyākhyāsyāmaḥ || tatra pṛṣṭhavaṃśam ubhayataḥ pratiśroṇīkarṇṇāvasthinī kaṭīkataruṇe nāma marmmaṇī | tatra śoṇitakṣayāt pāṇḍuvivarṇṇo hīnarūpo vā maraṇaṃ | pārśvayor jjaghanabahirbbhāge pṛṣṭhavaṃśam ubhayato kukundare nāma marmmaṇī | tatra sparśājñānam adhaḥkāye daurbbalyaṃ ceṣṭānāśaś ca bhavati | śroṇīkarṇṇayor upary āmāśayāc chādane pārśvāntaraprativahe nitambe nāma marmmaṇī | tatrādhaḥkāyaśoṣo daurbbalyam maraṇañ ca | adhaḥpārśvāntarapratibaddhe jaghanapārśvamadhye tiryag ūrddhvajaghanāt pārśvasandhī nāma marmmaṇī | tatra śoṇitapūrṇṇakoṣṭhatayā mriyate | stanamūlādṛjūbhayataḥ pṛṣṭhavaṃśasya bṛhatī nāma marmmaṇī | tatra śoṇitātipravṛttinimittair upadravair mmriyate | pṛṣṭhopari pṛṣṭhavaṃśam ubhayataḥ | trikasaṃbandhe 'nsaphale nāma marmmaṇī | tatra bāhuś cāpaśoṣaḥ | bāhuśīrṣagrīvāmadhye 'ṃśapīṭhaskandhasaṃ𑑎dhāne krakanyāse nāma marmmaṇī | tatra tabdhabāhur bbhagnapṛṣṭhatā vā bhavati | evam etāni caturddaśa pṛṣṭhamarmmāṇi vyākhyātāni ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁vyākhyāsyāmaḥ---tatra A₁₉₃₁pratiśroṇikāṇḍamasthinī A₁₉₃₁marmāṇī, A₁₉₃₁pāṇḍurvivarṇo A₁₉₃₁hīnarūpaśca A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁mriyate, A₁₉₃₁pārśvaja° A₁₉₃₁ubhayato (nātinimne) A₁₉₃₁marmāṇi, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁ceṣṭopaghātaś A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁śroṇīkāṇḍayor A₁₉₃₁āśayāc chādanau H°yāc chādane A₁₉₃₁°tibaddhau A₁₉₃₁nitambau A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁daurbalyāc A₁₉₃₁add ca A₁₉₃₁adhaḥpārśvāntarapratibaddhau A₁₉₃₁°madhyayos A₁₉₃₁ūrdhvaṃ ca ja° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁lohita° A₁₉₃₁°yateḥ A₁₉₃₁bṛhatyau A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁trikasaṃbaddhe A₁₉₃₁aṃsaphalake A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁bāhvoḥ A₁₉₃₁svāpaśoṣau; A₁₉₃₁bāhumūrdhagrī° A₁₉₃₁'sapīṭhasakandhanibandhanāvaṃsau A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁stabdhabāhutā; A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.6.27 ata ūrddhvam ūrddhajatrugatāni marmmā𑑎ṇy anuvyākhyāsyāmaḥ || tatra kaṇṭhanāḍīm ubhayataś catasro dhamanyo vyatyāsena | dve nīle dve ca manye nāma marmmaṇī | tatra mūkatā svaravaikṛtya maraṇam arasagrāhitā ca bhavati | grīvāyām ubhayataś catasraḥ sirāmātṛkā nāma marmmaṇī | tatra sadyo maraṇaṃ | śirogrīvayoḥ kṛkāṭikā nāma marmmaṇī | tatra calaśīrṣatā maraṇam vā | karṇṇapṛṣṭhato 'dhaḥsaṃsrite vidhure nāma marmmaṇī | tatra bādhiryaṃ | ghrāṇamārggam ubhayataḥ srotomārggapratibaddhe 'bhyantarataḥ phaṇe nāma marmmaṇī | tatra gandhājñānam āpādayati | bhruvoḥ pucchāntayor adhaḥ | netrayor bbāhyataḥ | apāṅgau nāma marmmaṇī | tatrāndhyadṛṣṭyupaghāto vā | bhruvoḥ pucchayor upary anukarṇṇalalāṭo śaṃkhau nāma marmmaṇī | tatra sadyo maraṇaṃ | bhruvor antare upari nimnayor āvarttau nāma marmmaṇī | tatrāpy āndhyaṃ dṛṣṭyupaghāto vā | āvarttaśaṃkhayor upari keśānte utkṣepau nāma marmmaṇī | tatra saśalyaḥ pākāt patitaśalyo vā jīve noddhṛtaśalyaḥ | bhruvor mmadhye sthapaṇir nnāma marmma | tatro𑑎tkṣepavat pañca sandhayaḥ śirasi vibhaktāḥ sīmantā nāma marmmaṇī | tatrotmādacittanāsābhyāṃ maraṇaṃ | ghrāṇasrotrākṣisandhijihvātarppaṇīnāṃ sirāṇāṃ madhye śiraḥ srotaḥ sannipātas tāni catvāri śṛṅgāṭakāni marmmāṇi | tatrāpi sadyo maraṇaṃ | mastakābhyantaram upariṣṭāt sirāsandhisannipāto romāvarttaḥ so 'dhipatir nnāma marmma | tatrāpi sadyo maraṇaṃ | evam etāny ūrddhvajatrugatāni saptatriṃśad marmmāṇi vyākhyātāni bhavanti ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁ūrdhvamūrdhvaja° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁vyākhyāsyāmaḥ---tatra A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁vyatyāsena, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁svaravaikṛtamara° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁ubhayataś-catasraḥ A₁₉₃₁sirā mātṛkāḥ, A₁₉₃₁sadyoma° A₁₉₃₁add sandhāne A₁₉₃₁kṛkāṭike A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁calamūrdhatā; A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁'dhaḥsaṃśrite A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁abhyan° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁bhrūpu° A₁₉₃₁adho A₁₉₃₁'kṣṇorbāhyato A₁₉₃₁'pāṅgau A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁tatrāndhyaṃ dṛ° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁nimnayor A₁₉₃₁āvartau A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁tatrāpyāndhyaṃ A₁₉₃₁dṛṣṭyupaghāto A₁₉₃₁vā; A₁₉₃₁pucchāntayor A₁₉₃₁karṇalalāṭayor A₁₉₃₁add madhye A₁₉₃₁śaṅkhau A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁tatra A₁₉₃₁sadyomaraṇaṃ; śaṅ° A₁₉₃₁keśānta A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁add jīvati A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁sthapanī A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁tatronmādabhayacittamāśairmaraṇaṃ; A₁₉₃₁ghrāṇaśrotrākṣijihvāsanta° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁sirāsan° A₁₉₃₁add śṛṅgāṭakāni, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°tarata A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁sadya A₁₉₃₁eva | A₁₉₃₁add saptatriṃśad A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.6.28 bhavanti cātra ślokāḥ ||
ūrvvyaḥ śirānsi ciṭipe sahakakṣapārśve ekaikamaṅgulamitā stanamūlagulphāḥ |
jñeyā dvir aṅgulamitā maṇibandhaṣaṣṭhā trīṇy eva jānuni paraṃ saha kurpparābhyāṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁ūrdhyaḥ A₁₉₃₁śirāṃsi A₁₉₃₁viṭape A₁₉₃₁add ca A₁₉₃₁saka° A₁₉₃₁°mitaṃ A₁₉₃₁stanapūrvamūlam || A₁₉₃₁viddhyaṅguladvayamitaṃ A₁₉₃₁°dhagulphaṃ A₁₉₃₁jānu A₁₉₃₁saparaṃ A₁₉₃₁kūrparābhyām ||
1931 ed. 3.6.29 hṛdvastikurccagudanābhi vadanti mūrddhni catvāri pañca ca gale daśa yāni ca dve ||
tāni ścapāṇitalakuñcitasanmitāni, śeṣāṇy avaihi parivartti tato gulārddhaṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁hṛdbastikūrca° A₁₉₃₁svapā° A₁₉₃₁śeṣāṇyavehi A₁₉₃₁parivistarato A₁₉₃₁'ṅgulārdhām ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add etatpramāṇamabhivīkṣya vadanti tajjñāḥ śastreṇa karmakaraṇaṃ parihṛtya kāryam || pārśvābhighātitamapīha nihanti marma tasmād dhi marmasadanaṃ parivarjanīyam ||
1931 ed. 3.6.31 cchinneṣu pāṇicaraṇeṣu sirā mukhānām ākuñcanāt khalu nṛṇām asṛg alpam eti |
chinneṣu pāṇicaraṇeṣu bhavanty atas tu, nāleṣu vṛttamathiteṣu yathotpalāni ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁narāṇāṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁saṅkocamīyurasṛgalpamato A₁₉₃₁nireti || A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁prāpyāmitavyasanamugramato A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁manuṣyāḥ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁saṃcchinniśākhataruvannidhanaṃ na yānti ||
1931 ed. 3.6.32 kṣipreṣu vatsatalajeṣu ca bhedadoṣāṅgacchatyasṛgbahurujañ ca karoti vāyuḥ |
evaṃ vināśam upayānti hi tatra viddhā kiñjalkapatramathanād iva paṅkajāni ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁tatra sataleṣu A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁hateṣu raktaṃ gacchatyatīva pavanaś ca rujaṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁add vṛkṣā ivāyudhavighātanikṛttamūlāḥ || A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.6.33 marmmāṇi śalyaviṣayādrdham udāharanti yasmād dhi marmmasu hatā na bhavanti marttyāḥ |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add tasmāt tayor abhihatasya tu pāṇipādaṃ chettavyamāśu maṇibandhanagulphadeśe || A₁₉₃₁°yārdham A₁₉₃₁ca A₁₉₃₁sadyaḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.6.34 jīvanti tatra yadi vaidyaguṇena ke cit te prāpnuvanti vikalatvam asaṃśayaṃ hi ||
sambhinnajarjjaritakoṣṭhaśiraḥkapālā jīvanti śastravihataiś ca śarīradeśaiḥ |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁vikalatvamasaṃ° A₁₉₃₁śastravi(ni)hataiś
1931 ed. 3.6.35 chinnaiś ca sakthibhujapādakarair aśeṣaṃ yeṣān na marmmapatitā vividhāḥ prahārāḥ ||
agnīṣomānilāḥ sattvaṃ rajaś ca tama eva ca |
prāyeṇa marmmasu nṛṇāṃ, santi bhūtātmanā saha ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°karair-aśeṣairyeṣāṃ A₁₉₃₁add somamārutatejāṃsi A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁rajaḥsattvatamāṃsi A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁prāyaśaḥ A₁₉₃₁puṃsāṃ A₁₉₃₁bhūtātmā A₁₉₃₁cāvatiṣṭhate ||
1931 ed. 3.6.36 tasmāt marmmasv abhihatā na jīvanti śarīriṇaḥ |
indriyārtheṣv asamvittir mmanobuddhiviparyayaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁abhihatās tasmān A₁₉₃₁asaṃprāptir
1931 ed. 3.6.37 rujaḥ sutīvrā vividhā bhavanty asuhate nare ||
hate kālāntare cāpi, dhruvo dhātukṣayo nṛṇāṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁ca A₁₉₃₁vividhās tīvrā A₁₉₃₁āśuhare A₁₉₃₁hate || A₁₉₃₁kālāntaraghne A₁₉₃₁tu
1931 ed. 3.6.38 tato dhātukṣayāj jantur vvedanābhiś ca naśyati |
hate vaikalyajanake, kevalaṃ vaidyanaipuṇāt ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°nane
1931 ed. 3.6.39 śarīrakṣayam āsādya vikalatvam avāpnuyāt |
viśalyaghneṣu vijñeyo yo hetuḥ prāg udīritaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁śarīraṃ A₁₉₃₁add kriyayā A₁₉₃₁yuktaṃ A₁₉₃₁vijñeyaṃ A₁₉₃₁add pūrvoktaṃ A₁₉₃₁yac A₁₉₃₁ca A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁kāraṇam ||
1931 ed. 3.6.40 rujākarāṇi marmmāṇi kṣatāni vividhā rujaḥ |
kurvvanty ante ca vaikalyaṃ kuvaidyavaśago yadi ||
K, N, L
1931 ed. 3.6.41 chedabhedābhighātebhyo dahanād dāraṇāt tathā |
upaghātam vijānīyāt marmmaṇāṃ tulyalakṣaṇaṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁dāraṇā A₁₉₃₁dapi ||
1931 ed. 3.6.42 marmmābhighātas tu ca kaś cid asti yo 'lpātyayo vāpi niratyayo vā |
prāyeṇa marmmasv abhitāḍitās tu vaikalyam arcchanty atha vā mriyante ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁ṛcchanty
1931 ed. 3.6.43 marmmāṇy adhiṣṭhāya hi ye vikārā mūrcchanti kāye vividhā narāṇām |
prāyeṇa te kṛcchratamā bhavanti narasya yatnair api sādhyamānāḥ || ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁marmāṇ A₁₉₃₁yadhi°

iti śārīre ṣaṣṭho 'dhyāyaḥ || 0 ||

[Adhyāya 7. Draft based on MS H]

1931 ed. 3.7.1 athātaḥ sirāvarṇṇanavibhaktiṃ śārīram vyākhyāsyāmaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°rṇavibhaktiṃ A₁₉₃₁add nāma
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add yathovāca bhagavān dhanvantariḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.7.3 sapta śirāśatāni bhavanti | yābhir idaṃ śarīram ārāma iva jalaharaṇībhiḥ | kedāra iva ca kulyābhir upasnihyate cākuñcanaprasāraṇābhir vviśeṣair ddrumapatrasevanīnām iva tāsām pratānām tāsāṃ khalu nābhimūlan tataḥ prasaranty ūrdhvam adhas tiryak ca ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁sirā° A₁₉₃₁jalahāriṇībhiḥ A₁₉₃₁add 'nugṛhyate A₁₉₃₁°ṇādibhir A₁₉₃₁add ca Hcāsām A₁₉₃₁pratānāḥ; A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁nābhir mūlaṃ, A₁₉₃₁add ca Hurdhvam
1931 ed. 3.7.4 bhavati cātra ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁bhavataś
1931 ed. 3.7.4.1 yāvantyas tu sirāḥ kāye sambhavanti śarīriṇaḥ |
nābhyāṃ sarvvāṇi baddhās tāḥ pratanvanti samantataḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁yāvatyas A₁₉₃₁śarīriṇām || A₁₉₃₁sarvā A₁₉₃₁nibaddhāstāḥ Hpratanvati
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add nābhisthāḥ prāṇināṃ prāṇāḥ prāṇān nābhir vyupāśritā || sirābhir āvṛtā nābhiś cakranābhir ivārakaiḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.7.6 tāsāṃ khalu mūlasirāś catvāriśat tāsu daśavātavahāḥ | daśa pittavahāḥ | daśa śleṣmavahāḥ | daśa raktavahā iti | tāsāṃ khalu vātavahānāṃ sirāṇāṃ vātasthānaga tānām pañcasaptatiśataṃ bhavati | tāvanty eva pittavahāḥ pittasthāne | raktavahāś ca yakṛtplīhāḥ | kaphavahāś ca kaphasthāne | evam etāni sapta śirāśatāni bhavanti |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁catvāriṃśat; A₁₉₃₁tāsāṃ A₁₉₃₁vātavāhinyo A₁₉₃₁pittavāhinyo A₁₉₃₁kaphavāhinyo A₁₉₃₁add daśa A₁₉₃₁raktavāhinyaḥ | A₁₉₃₁tu A₁₉₃₁vātavāhinīnāṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°gatānāṃ A₁₉₃₁tāvatya A₁₉₃₁pittavāhinyaḥ A₁₉₃₁kaphavāhinyaś A₁₉₃₁kaphasthāne, A₁₉₃₁raktavāhinyaś A₁₉₃₁yakṛtplīhnoḥ, A₁₉₃₁sirā° A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.7.7 tatra vātavahānām ekasmin sakthini pañcaviṃśatiḥ sirā bhavanti | etenetarasakti vāhū ca vyākhyātau | koṣṭhe catustriṃśat tāsāṃ gudameḍhrasaṃśritāḥ śroṇyām aṣṭau dve dve pārśvayoḥ ṣaṭpṛṣṭhe tāvantya evodare daśa vakṣasi | jatruṇa ūrddhvam ekacatvāriṃśat tāsām aṣṭau jihvāyāṃ | nava nāsāyāṃ | dve grīvāyāṃ | hanvoś catasraḥ | netrayoḥ ṣaṭ lalāṭe tisraḥ karṇṇayoś catasraḥ | dve śaṃkhayoḥ | tisraḥ śirasītyevam etat pañcasaptatiśataṃ | vātavahānāṃ śirāṇāṃ vyākhyātaṃ | eṣa eva vibhāgaḥ śeṣāṇām evam etāni sapta śirāśatāni vyākhyātāni bhavanti |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁vātavāhinyaḥ sirā A₁₉₃₁sakthni A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°sakthi A₁₉₃₁bāhū A₁₉₃₁add viśeṣatastu A₁₉₃₁caturstriṃśat; A₁₉₃₁gudameḍhrāśritāḥ A₁₉₃₁śroṇyāmaṣṭau, A₁₉₃₁ṣaṭ pṛṣṭhe, A₁₉₃₁tāvatya A₁₉₃₁eva codare, A₁₉₃₁ekacatvāriṃśajjatruṇa A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁caturdaśa A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁karṇayoścatasraḥ, A₁₉₃₁add nava jihvāyāṃ, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁add nāsikāyāṃ, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁aṣṭau A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁netrayoḥ, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁evam A₁₉₃₁sirāṇāṃ A₁₉₃₁add bhavati | A₁₉₃₁add api | viśeṣatas tu pittavāhinyo netrayor daśa, karṇayor dve; evaṃ raktavāhāḥ kaphavahāś ca | A₁₉₃₁sirā° A₁₉₃₁add savibhāgāni A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.7.8 bhavanti cātra ||
K, N, L
1931 ed. 3.7.8.0 yadā vāyur aduṣṭas tu sevate svavahāḥ sirāḥ |
tadāstuvalavarṇṇaujaḥ prasīdec ca manas tathā ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L
1931 ed. 3.7.8.1 kriyānām apratighātam amohaṃ vuddhikarmmaṇāṃ |
karoty anyān guṇām̐ś cāpi sirāḥ pavanasvaścaran ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁kriyāṇāmapratīghātamamohaṃ A₁₉₃₁buddhi° A₁₉₃₁karotyanyān A₁₉₃₁guṇāṃś A₁₉₃₁pavanaścaran ||
1931 ed. 3.7.9 yadā tu kupito vāyuḥ stāḥ śirā pratipadyate |
tadāsya rogā jāyante vividhā vātasambhavāḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁svāḥ A₁₉₃₁sirāḥ A₁₉₃₁add vividhā A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.7.9.1 yadā tvakupitam pittaṃ sevate svavahāḥ sirāḥ |
avyāpannas tadāgnis tu samyak carati bhojanaṃ ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L
1931 ed. 3.7.10 bhrājiṣṇutām annarucim agner ddīptim arogatāṃ |
karoty anyān guṇām̐ś cāpi pittam atmasirāś caran ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁bhrājiṣṇutāmannarucimagnidīptimaro° A₁₉₃₁add saṃsarpatsvāḥ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁sirāḥ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁kuryāc A₁₉₃₁cānyānguṇūnapi ||
1931 ed. 3.7.11 yadā tu kupitam pittaṃ tāḥ sirāḥ pratipadyate |
tadāsya rogā jāyante vividhā pittasambhavāḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁prakutitaṃ A₁₉₃₁add sevate A₁₉₃₁svavahāḥ A₁₉₃₁tadā'sya A₁₉₃₁vividhā A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.7.11.1 yadā tv akupitaḥ śleṣmā svāḥ sirāḥ saṃprapadyate |
āśayāḥ sandhayaś caiva varttantesya nirāmayāḥ ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L
1931 ed. 3.7.12 sneham aṅgeṣu sandhīnāṃ sthairyam valam adīnatāṃ |
karoty anyān guṇām̐ś cāpi valāsa svasirāś caran ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁snehamaṅgeṣu A₁₉₃₁balamudīrṇatām || A₁₉₃₁karotyanyān A₁₉₃₁guṇāṃś A₁₉₃₁balāsaḥ A₁₉₃₁svāḥ sirāścaran ||
1931 ed. 3.7.13 yadā tu kupitaḥ śleṣmā tāḥ sirāḥ pratipadyate |
tadāsya rogā jāyante vividhāḥ śleṣmasambhavāḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁svāḥ A₁₉₃₁add vividhā A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.7.13.1 yadā tv akupitaṃ raktaṃ sevate svavahāḥ sirāḥ |
tadāsya samyag jānāti sparśānāṃ tu śubhāśubhaṃ ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L
1931 ed. 3.7.14 varṇṇaprasādanaṃ sthairyaṃ dhātūnāṃ puṣṭim eva ca |
karoty anyān guṇām̐ś cāpi raktam ātmasirāś caran ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁dhātūnāṃ pūraṇaṃ A₁₉₃₁sparśajñānamasaṃśayam || A₁₉₃₁add svāḥ sirāḥ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁saṃcaradraktaṃ A₁₉₃₁kuryāc A₁₉₃₁cānyān A₁₉₃₁guṇānapi || A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.7.15 yadā tu kupitaṃ raktaṃ tāḥ sirāḥ pratipadyate |
tadāsya rogā jāyante vividhā raktasambhavāḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add sevate A₁₉₃₁svavahāḥ A₁₉₃₁tadā'sya A₁₉₃₁vividhā A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.7.15.1 apraduṣṭāḥ śarīrāṇi dhārayanti rasair hitaiḥ |
kalpante ca vikārāya praduṣṭā nātra saṃśayaḥ ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L
1931 ed. 3.7.16 na hi vātasirāḥ kaścit na pittaṃ kevalaṃ sirāḥ |
śleṣmāṇañ ca vahanty etāḥ sarvvāḥ sarvvavahāḥ sirāḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁vātaṃ sirāḥ A₁₉₃₁kāścinna A₁₉₃₁tathā || A₁₉₃₁śleṣmāṇāṃ A₁₉₃₁ A₁₉₃₁vahantyetā A₁₉₃₁ataḥ A₁₉₃₁smṛtāḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.7.17 praduṣṭānān tu doṣāṇāṃ mūrcchitānām pradhānatān |
dhruvam unmārggagamanaṃ sarvvāḥ sarvvavahā hyataḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁praduṣṭānāṃ A₁₉₃₁hi A₁₉₃₁pradhāvatām || A₁₉₃₁dhruvamunmāragagamanamataḥ A₁₉₃₁sarvavahāḥ A₁₉₃₁smṛtāḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.7.18 tatrāruṇā vātavahā nīlāḥ pittavahāḥ sirāḥ |
...
asṛgvahāś ca rohiṇyo gauryaḥ śleṣmavahāḥ sirāḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁vātavahāḥ A₁₉₃₁add pūryante vāyunā A₁₉₃₁sirāḥ || A₁₉₃₁pittāduṣṇāś A₁₉₃₁add ca nīlāśca, śītā gauryaḥ A₁₉₃₁sthirāḥ kaphāt || A₁₉₃₁tu A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁sirā nātyuṣṇaśītalāḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.7.19 ata ūrddhvaṃ pravakṣyāmi yās tv avadhyāḥ sirā nṛṇāṃ |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add na A₁₉₃₁vidhyedāḥ A₁₉₃₁sirā A₁₉₃₁add bhiṣak || vaikslyaṃ A₁₉₃₁add maraṇaṃ cāpi A₁₉₃₁vyadhāttāsāṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁djrivaṃ A₁₉₃₁add bhavet ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add sirāśatāni catvāri vidyācchākhāsu buddhimān || ṣaṭtriṃśac ca śataṃ koṣṭhe catuḥṣaṣṭiṃ ca mūrdhani ||
1931 ed. 3.7.21 śākhāsu ṣoḍaśā vyadhyāḥ koṣṭhe dvātriṃśad eva tu |
jatrorūrddhvan tu pañcāśad avyadhyāḥ parikīrttitāḥ |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁ṣoḍaśa A₁₉₃₁sirāḥ A₁₉₃₁dvātriṃśadeva A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁pañcāśajjatruṇaścordhvamavyadhyāḥ
1931 ed. 3.7.19cd vaikalyaṃ maraṇam vāśu vyadhyāt tāsāṃ dhruvam bhavet ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L
1931 ed. 3.7.22 tatra sirāḥ śatam ekasmin sakthini bhavanti | tāsāṃ jaladhārā tvekā tisraś cābhyantarataḥ | tatrorvvīsaṃjñe dve lohitākṣa saṃjñakā tās tv avyadhyāḥ | etenetarasakthi vāhū ca vyākhyātau | evam aśastrakṛtyāḥ ṣoḍaśaśākhāsu | śroṇyāṃ dvātriṃśat | tāsām aṣṭāvaśastrakṛtyāḥ | dve dve vaṃkṣaṇaciṭipayor evaṃ kaṭīkataruṇayoś ca | aṣṭāvaṣṭāv ekaikasmin pārśve tāsām ekaika ūrddhvage ubhayato dve pārśve sandhisaṃśrite ca pariharet | caturvviṃśatiḥ pṛṣṭhe pṛṣṭhavaṃśam ubhayataḥ | tāsāṃ vṛhatī saṃjñe ūrddhvagāminye dve pariharet | tāvantya evodare tāsāṃ meḍhropari romarājīm ubhayato dve dve pariharet | catvāriśaṃd vakṣasi tāsāṃ caturddaśāśastrakṛtyā hṛdi dve stanamūle saṃśrite tu dve dve pariharet | stanam ubhayataś catasraḥ pariharet | dve dve cāpālāpe stambheṣv ity e va dvātriṃśadaśastrakṛtyāḥ | śroṇī pṛṣṭhodaroraḥsu bhavanti catiḥṣaṣṭiśataṃ mūrddhani tāsāṃ viṃśatiḥ | śirodharāyāṃ tāsām aṣṭau catasraś ca marmmasaṃjñāḥ | dve kṛkāṭikayos tāvantya eva vidhurayoḥ hanvor ubhayato aṣṭāvaṣṭau tāsāṃ tu sandhinivaṃdhanyau dve dve pariharet | ṣaṭtriṃśaj jihvāyāṃ tāsām adhaḥ ṣoḍaśāśastrakṛtyā rasavāhinyaḥ | catuvviṃśatir nnāsāyāṃ tāsām aupanāsyāś catasraḥ parihare tāsām eva ca tāluny ekā ṣaṭtriṃśad ubhayor nnetrayoḥ | tāsām ekaikām apāṅgayoḥ pariharet | lalāṭe ṣaṣṭistāsāṃ keśāntānugatāś catasraḥ pariharet | āvarttayor ekaikāsthapaṇyāś caikā pariharttavyāḥ karṇṇayoḥ pañ ca pañca | tāsāṃ śabdavahām ekaikāṃ pariharet | śaṃkhayoś ca tāvantya eva tāsāṃ śaṃkhasandhigatām ekaikām pariharet | dvādaśamūrddhani tāsām utkṣepayoḥ | dve dve sīma manteṣv ekaikām adhipatau parihared iti ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁sirāśatameka° A₁₉₃₁sakthni A₁₉₃₁bhavati; A₁₉₃₁jāladharā A₁₉₃₁cābhyantarāḥ---ta° A₁₉₃₁°kṣasaṃjñā caikā, A₁₉₃₁etāstvavyadhyāḥ; A₁₉₃₁bāhū A₁₉₃₁evamaśa° A₁₉₃₁ṣoḍaśa śā° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁dvātriṃśacchroṇyāṃ, A₁₉₃₁tāsāmaṣṭāvaśastrakṛtyāḥ---dve A₁₉₃₁viṭapayoḥ, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°ṇayośca; aṣṭāvaṣṭāvekaikasmin A₁₉₃₁tāsāmekaikāmūrdhvagāṃ A₁₉₃₁pariharet, A₁₉₃₁pārśvasandhigate A₁₉₃₁dve; A₁₉₃₁catasro viṃśatiś A₁₉₃₁add ca A₁₉₃₁pṛṣṭhavaṃśamubha° A₁₉₃₁tāsāmūrdhvagāminyau dve A₁₉₃₁°redbṛhatīsire; A₁₉₃₁tāvatya A₁₉₃₁meḍhopari A₁₉₃₁romarājīmubha° A₁₉₃₁catvāriṃśadvakṣasi, A₁₉₃₁°kṛtyāḥ---hṛdaye A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁dve, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁stanamūle, A₁₉₃₁stanarohitāpalāpastambheṣūbhayato A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁'ṣṭau; A₁₉₃₁evaṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁catuḥṣaṣṭisirāśataṃ A₁₉₃₁jatruṇa ūrdhvaṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁bhavati; tatra A₁₉₃₁ṣaṭpañcāśacchiro° A₁₉₃₁tāsāmaṣṭau A₁₉₃₁marmasaṃjñāḥ pariharet, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁dve A₁₉₃₁add evaṃ grīvāyāṃ ṣoḍaśāvyadhyāḥ; A₁₉₃₁'ṣṭāv aṣṭau, A₁₉₃₁sandhidhamanyau A₁₉₃₁ṣaṭtriṃśajjihvāyāṃ, A₁₉₃₁tāsāmadhaḥ A₁₉₃₁rasavahe dve, A₁₉₃₁add vāgvahe A₁₉₃₁ca dve; dvirdvādaśa A₁₉₃₁tāsāmaupanāsikyaścatasraḥ A₁₉₃₁pariharet, A₁₉₃₁tālunyekāṃ A₁₉₃₁add mṛdāvuddeśe; A₁₉₃₁aṣṭatriṃśadubhayor A₁₉₃₁tāsāmekāmapāṅ° A₁₉₃₁add karṇayor daśa, tāsāṃ śabdavāhinīmekaikāṃ pariharet; nāsānetragatās tu A₁₉₃₁ṣaṣṭiḥ, tāsāṃ A₁₉₃₁°gatāścatasraḥ A₁₉₃₁ekaikā, sthapanyāṃ A₁₉₃₁°rtavyā; A₁₉₃₁śaṅkhayor A₁₉₃₁daśa, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁śaṅkhasandhigatāmekaikāṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁(ityetā A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁nāsānetragatā A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁boddhavyāḥ) A₁₉₃₁dvādaśa mūrdhni, A₁₉₃₁pariharet, A₁₉₃₁sīman° A₁₉₃₁add ekām A₁₉₃₁add iti; evam aśastrakṛtyāḥ A₁₉₃₁pañcāśaj A₁₉₃₁add jatruṇa ūrdhvam
1931 ed. 3.7.23 bhavanti cātra ślokāḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁bhavati A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.7.23.1 sirāśatānāṃ saptānāṃ śarīreṣu śarīriṇāṃ |
aśastrakṛtyā navatis tathāṣṭau ca vinirddiśet | ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁vyāpnuvantyabhito dehaṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁nābhitaḥ prasṛtāḥ A₁₉₃₁sirāḥ || A₁₉₃₁pratānāḥ A₁₉₃₁add padminīkandādbisādīnāṃ yathā A₁₉₃₁jalam || A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.7.23.2 spandinyau jaladhāriṇyau yāś ca marmma samāśritāḥ |
avyadhyās tā vijānīyāt snāyusandhigatāśca yāḥ ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L
1931 ed. 3.7.23.3 vaikalpamaraṇañ cāpi vyadhādāsāṃ dhruvaṃ bhavet |
vyāpnuyād vākhilaṃ dehaṃ nābhitaḥ prasṛtāḥ sirāḥ ||
pratānāḥ padminī kandā dvisādīnāṃ yathājalaṃ ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L

iti śārīre saptamo dhyāyaḥ ||

[Adhyāya 8. Draft based on MS H]

1931 ed. 3.8.1 athāto vyadhavidhiṃ śārīraṃ vyākhyāsyāmaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁sirāvyadhavidhiśā°
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add yathovāca bhagavān dhanvantariḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.8.3 tatra bālasthavirabhīrurūkṣakṣatakṣīṇamadyādhvastrīkarṣitānāsitavāntaviraktadantavastiklībagarbbhiṇīkāsaśvāsaśoṣapravṛddhajvarātīsārākṣepakapakṣāghātopavāsapīḍitānāṃ sirānavyadhyāḥ || kiṃ kāraṇameṣāṃ tu khalu vedhādindriyasaṃmohaḥ śoṣo vā bhavati | raktapittino raktātyayād vātakopo mṛtyurvvā | garbbhiṇyas tu garbbhaśoṣapatanahīnāṃgānāyuṣkatā vā garbbhasya || bhavati cātra ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°rarūkṣakṣatakṣīṇabhīrupariśrāntamadyādhvastrīkarṣitavamitaviriktāsthāpitānuvāsitajāgaritaklībakṛśagārbhiṇīnāṃ kāsaśvāsaśoṣapravṛddhajvarākṣepakapakṣāghātopavāsapipāsāmūrcchāprapīḍitānāṃ A₁₉₃₁add ca A₁₉₃₁sirāṃ na vidhyet, yāś A₁₉₃₁add cāvyadhyāḥ, vyadhyāś A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁cādṛṣṭāḥ, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁dṛṣṭāś A₁₉₃₁cāyantritāḥ, A₁₉₃₁yantritāś A₁₉₃₁cānutthitā iti || A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.8.3a pratiṣiddhānāvaśekāṃ tu śeṣāṇām api dehināṃ | vyādhervvivṛddhir mṛtyurvvā sirāvedhena sambhavet ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L
1931 ed. 3.8.3b yāś cāvyadhyā dṛṣṭādṛṣṭāś cāyantritāyantritā notthitā iti ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L
1931 ed. 3.8.4 śoṇitamokṣasādhyāś ca vikārāḥ prāgabhihitāḥ | teṣv apakṣeṣu cānyeṣu cānubhukteṣu yathābhyāsam anatyayañ ca sirāṃ vyadhayet ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁śoṇitāvasekasādhyāś A₁₉₃₁add ye A₁₉₃₁°hitāsteṣu A₁₉₃₁cāpakveṣv A₁₉₃₁anyeṣu A₁₉₃₁cānukteṣu A₁₉₃₁yathānyāyaṃ A₁₉₃₁vidhyet ||
1931 ed. 3.8.5 pratiṣiddhānām api ca viṣopasargge sirāvyadhanam apratiṣiddhaṃ
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°sargātyayikeṣu A₁₉₃₁°dhanamapratiṣiddham ||
1931 ed. 3.8.6 tatra snigdhasvinnam āturaṃ yathā doṣapratyanīkaṃ dravaprāyam annaṃ bhuktavantaṃ yavāgūm pītam vā yathākālam upasthāpyāsīnaṃ sthitam vā prāṇān abādhamānaḥ | plotapaṭṭaś carmmāntarvvalkalalatānām anyatamena yantreṇa yantrayitvā nātigāḍhannātiśithilaṃ śarīrapradeśam āsādya vidhivacchastramādāya yathoktāṃ sirāṃ vyadhayet |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁snigdhasvinnamāturaṃ A₁₉₃₁yathādo° A₁₉₃₁dravaprāyamannaṃ A₁₉₃₁pītavantaṃ A₁₉₃₁ A₁₉₃₁prāṇānabā° A₁₉₃₁vastrapaṭṭaca° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁nātigāḍhaṃ nā° A₁₉₃₁°deśamāsādya A₁₉₃₁prāptaṃ śastra° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁vidhyet ||
1931 ed. 3.8.7 tatra vyadhyasirāṃ | naivātiśīte nātyuṣṇe na pravāte na ca durddine | sirāṇāṃ vyadhanaṃ kāryam aroge vā kadācana ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁cābhrite || A₁₉₃₁kāryamaroge
1931 ed. 3.8.8 tatra vyadhyasirāṃ puruṣaṃ pratyād ity amukhamarannimātrocchrite niveśyāsane sakthnor ākuñcitayor nniveśya kurpparasandhidvayaṃ hastāvantagūḍhāṅguṣṭhakṛtamuṣṭīm anyayo sthāpayitvā yantraśāṭakena parikṣipya grīvāyām anyena paścāt sthitena puruṣeṇa vāmahastena śāṭakāntadvayaṃ grāhayitvā sirotthāpanārtham asṛksrāvaṇārthañ ca yantram pramāṇena pīḍayet | karmmapuruṣaś ca mukhaṃ vāyunā pūrayet | uttamāṅgagatānām eṣa sirotthāpam ayantravidhiḥ | sthitasakthim īṣet kuñcitapādam uccaiḥ sthāpayitvā vyadhapradeśasyopari samyag yantram badhvā pādasirām vidhyet | upaviṣṭasya hastaṃ gūḍhāṃṣṭhaguṣṭhanibaddhamuṣṭiṃ samyagāsane sthāpayitvā hastasirāṃ vidhyet | gṛdhrasīviśvacyorākuñcitajānukurpparasya śroṇīpṛṣṭhaskandheṣūnnamitapṛṣṭhasya udarorasau prasārito rasaḥ sphurjjitadehasya bāhūbhyām avalambamānasya pārśvayoḥ | avanamitameḍhrasya meḍhraṃ | unnāmitavidaṣṭajihvāsyādhojihvāyām | ativyātānānanasya tāluni dantamūle ca | evaṃ yantropāyān anyām̐ś ca sirotthāpanahetūn buddhyāvekṣya śarīravaśena vyādhivaśena ca vidadhyād iti |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁vyadhyasiraṃ A₁₉₃₁pratyādityamukhamaratnimā° A₁₉₃₁upave° A₁₉₃₁sakthnorākuñ° A₁₉₃₁kūrparau sandhidvayasyopari A₁₉₃₁°targūḍhāṅguṣṭhakṛtamuṣṭīmanyayoḥ A₁₉₃₁yantraṇaśāṭakaṃ grīvāmuṣṭyor upari A₁₉₃₁parikṣipyānyena A₁₉₃₁add puruṣeṇa A₁₉₃₁paś cātsthitena A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°stenottānena A₁₉₃₁tato A₁₉₃₁add vaidyo brūyāt---dakṣiṇahastena A₁₉₃₁sirotthāpanārthaṃ A₁₉₃₁pṛṣṭhamadhye A₁₉₃₁pīḍayeti, A₁₉₃₁karmapuruṣaṃ A₁₉₃₁vāyupūrṇamukhaṃ A₁₉₃₁sthāpayet; A₁₉₃₁eṣauttamāṅgagatānāmantarmukhavarjānāṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁sirāṇāṃ A₁₉₃₁nyadhane yantraṇavidhiḥ | A₁₉₃₁tatra pādamīṣatsaṃkucitamuccaiḥ kṛtvā vyadhyasirapādaṃ A₁₉₃₁jānusandheradhaḥ A₁₉₃₁add śāṭakenāveṣṭya A₁₉₃₁hastābhyāṃ prapīḍyāgulphaṃ A₁₉₃₁vyadhyapra° A₁₉₃₁caturaṅgule A₁₉₃₁plotādīnāmanyatamena A₁₉₃₁add A₁₉₃₁athopariṣṭāddhastau A₁₉₃₁gūḍhāṅguṣṭhakṛtamuṣṭī A₁₉₃₁add sukhopaviṣṭasya pūrvavadyantraṃ baddhvā A₁₉₃₁°viśvācyoḥ saṅkucitajānukūrparasya | A₁₉₃₁°ṣūnnāmitapṛṣṭhasyāvākśiraskasyopaviṣṭasya visphūrjitapṛṣṭhasya vidhyet | udarorasoḥ A₁₉₃₁prasāritoraskasyonnāmitaśiraskasya A₁₉₃₁visphūrji° A₁₉₃₁bāhubhyāmavalambamānadehasya A₁₉₃₁avanāmi° A₁₉₃₁meḍhre | A₁₉₃₁unnamitavidaṣṭajihvāgrasyā° A₁₉₃₁°tānanasya A₁₉₃₁°leṣu A₁₉₃₁°yānanyāṃśca A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.8.9 māṃsaleṣv avakāseṣu vrīhimukhena yavamātraṃ nidadhyād vrīhimātram vā | ato nyathārddhayavamātram asthnām upari kuṭhārikayā ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁avakāśeṣu A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁add śastraṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁'nyeṣv ardha° A₁₉₃₁add vrīhimātraṃ vā A₁₉₃₁vrīhimukhena, asthnām A₁₉₃₁add vidhyedardhayavamātram ||
1931 ed. 3.8.10 bhavaṃti cātra || vyabhre varṣāsu vidhyeta grīṣmakāleṣu śītale | hemantakāle madhyāhne śastrakālās trayaḥ smṛtāḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁vidhyeta(ttu) A₁₉₃₁°le tu A₁₉₃₁śastrakālāstrayaḥ
1931 ed. 3.8.11 dviprakārapramathitadhārayā yāsravedasṛk | muhūrttaṃ ruddhvā tiṣṭhec ca suviddhāntāṃ vinirddiśet ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁samyakśastranipātena dhā° A₁₉₃₁yā sra° A₁₉₃₁ruddhā A₁₉₃₁suviddhāṃ tāṃ
1931 ed. 3.8.12 yathā kusumbhapuṣpebhyaḥ pūrvvaṃ sravati pītikā | tathā sirāsu viddhāsu duṣṭam agre pravarttate ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°pebhayaḥ A₁₉₃₁duṣṭamagre
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add mūrcchitasyātibhītasya śrāntasya tṛṣitasya ca || na vahanti sirā viddhāstathā'nutthitayantritāḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.8.14 kṣīṇasya bahudoṣasya mūrcchayopadrutasya vā | bhūyo 'parāhṇe visrāvyāt tūttare 'hani vāyunaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁mūrcchayā+abhihatasya A₁₉₃₁ca || A₁₉₃₁visrāvyā A₁₉₃₁sā'paredyustryahe A₁₉₃₁'pi A₁₉₃₁vā ||
1931 ed. 3.8.15 saśeṣadoṣarudhiram api kuryād vicakṣaṇaḥ | na cātinisṛtaṃ kuryāc cheṣaṃ saṃśamanair jjayet ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add raktaṃ A₁₉₃₁°doṣaṃ A₁₉₃₁tu A₁₉₃₁add api A₁₉₃₁cātiprasrūtaṃ A₁₉₃₁saṃśamanairjayet ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add balino bahudoṣasya vayaḥsthasya śarīriṇaḥ || paraṃ pramāṇamicchanti prasthaṃ śoṇitamokṣaṇe ||
1931 ed. 3.8.17 tatra pādadāhapādaharṣacipyavātaśoṇitapādakaṇṭakavipādikāpādadārīprabhṛtiṣu rogeṣu kṣipramarmmopariṣṭād dvyaṅgule vrīhimukhena sirāṃ vyadhayet | ślīpadeṣu yathoktaṃ kroṣṭukaśirṣavātavedanāsu sakthisaṃsritāṃ | gulphasandher upari caturaṅgule apacyāmindrabaster adhastād dvyaṅgule | jānusandher upari caturaṃgule gṛdhrasyāmūrusaṃdhisanniviṣṭāṃ | galagaṇḍe śroṇipratisamantāt pravāhikāyāṃśūlinyāṃ parivarttikopadaṃśaśūkavyāpatsu meḍhramadhye | etenetarasakthibāhūvyākhyātau || viśeṣatas tu vāmabāhukurpparasandhāvabhyantarato bāhumadhye plīhni etām eva dakṣiṇabāhuyakṛddālye | etām eva ca kāsaśvāsayor apyādiśanti | gṛdhrasyāmiva vipaṃcyām vāmapārśvakakṣastanāntarayor antarasthām vidradhau pārśvaśūle ca | etām eva ca kaphodare | dakṣiṇapārśve bāhuśoṣāpabāhukayor bbāhumadhye eke vadanty aṃsamadhye trikasandhimadhyagatān tṛtīyake | skandhasandhigatānām anyatarapārśvasaṃsthitānāñ caturthake | hanusandhimadhyagatām apasmāre | śaṃkhasandhigatānām unmāde | jihvārogedī 3ṣv adhojihvāyāṃ | dantavyādhiṣu dantamūle | tāluni tālavye ca | karṇṇayor upari samantāt karṇṇaśūle tadroge ca | gandhāghrāṇe nāsārogeṣu nāsāgre | timirākṣipākaprabhṛtiṣv akṣcāmayeṣūpanāsyāṃ lālāṭīm āpāṃgī vā | etām eva śirorogādhimanthaprabhṛtiṣu ca rogeṣu |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁pādadāhapādaharṣāvabāhukacippavisarpavātaśoṇitavātakaṇṭakavicarcikā° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁kṣipramarmaṇa upa° A₁₉₃₁vidhyet, , A₁₉₃₁ślīpade A₁₉₃₁add taccikitsite A₁₉₃₁yathā vakṣyate, A₁₉₃₁kroṣṭukaśiraḥkhañjapaṅulavā° A₁₉₃₁jaṅghāyāṃ A₁₉₃₁gulphasyopari A₁₉₃₁°basteradhastād A₁₉₃₁jānusandheruparyadho vā A₁₉₃₁gṛdhrasyāṃ, ūrumūlasaṃśritāṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°kthi bāhū ca vyākhyātau; A₁₉₃₁vāmabāhau kūrparasandherabhyan° A₁₉₃₁bāhūmadhye A₁₉₃₁add kaniṣṭhikānāmikayor A₁₉₃₁madhye vā, A₁₉₃₁evaṃ A₁₉₃₁°bāhau yakṛdākhye(kaphodare ca, ) A₁₉₃₁viśvācyāṃ, A₁₉₃₁add śroṇiṃ prati samantād dvyaṅgule pravāhikāyāṃ A₁₉₃₁śūlinyāṃ, parivartikopadaṃśaśūkadoṣaśukravyāpatsu meḍhramadhye, (vṛṣaṇayoḥ A₁₉₃₁add pārśve A₁₉₃₁mūtravṛddhyāṃ, A₁₉₃₁nābheradhaścaturaṅgule A₁₉₃₁add sevanyāṃ A₁₉₃₁vāmapārśve A₁₉₃₁dakodare, ) A₁₉₃₁vāmapārśve A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁kakṣāstanayor antare A₁₉₃₁'ntarvidradhau pārśvaśūle A₁₉₃₁add ca , A₁₉₃₁bāhuśoṣāvabā° A₁₉₃₁apyeke A₁₉₃₁vadantyaṃsayor antare, A₁₉₃₁°gatāṃ A₁₉₃₁adhaḥskandhasandhigatāmanyatarapārśvasaṃsthitāṃ A₁₉₃₁°gatāmapasmāre, A₁₉₃₁śaṅkhakeśāntasandhigatāmuro 'pāṅgalalāṭeṣu A₁₉₃₁conmāde, A₁₉₃₁ca, A₁₉₃₁tālvyeṣu, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁tadrogeṣu A₁₉₃₁gandhāgrahaṇe A₁₉₃₁vāsā° A₁₉₃₁add ca A₁₉₃₁°tiṣvakṣyāmayeṣūpanāsike A₁₉₃₁lālāṭyāmapāṅgyāṃ A₁₉₃₁etā A₁₉₃₁add ca A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁rogeṣviti ||
1931 ed. 3.8.18 tatra durvviddhātividdhākuñcitā piccitā kuṭṭitā aprasrutānutīrṇṇā anteviddhāpariśuṣkākūṇitā vepitā anutthitaviddhā | avyadhyaviddhā śastrahatā tiryagviddhā | aviddhā vidrutā dhenukā punaḥ punarvviddhā marmmasirāsnāyvasthisandhiṣu viddhā ceti | viṃśatiṃ duṣṭavyadhyā bhavanti ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add ata ūrdhvaṃ duṣṭavyadhanamanuvyākhyāsyāmaḥ, A₁₉₃₁°dhā kuñcitā A₁₉₃₁kuṭṭitā'prasrutā'tyudīrṇā+ante 'bhihatā pariśuṣkā kūṇitāvepitā'nu° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°ddhā'paviddhā'vyadhyā A₁₉₃₁māṃsasirāsnāyvasthisandhimarmasu A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁viṃśatirduṣṭavyadhāḥ || A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.8.19 tatra sūkṣmaśastrapraṇidhānān nāsṛgvyaktaṃ sravati | tatra rujā śophau bhavataḥ | sā durvviddhā nāma | pramāṇātiriktaviddhāyāmantaḥ śoṇitam praviśatyatipravṛttirvvā bhavati sātividdhā nāma kuñcitāyām apyevaṃ | kuṇṭhaśastrapramathitāpṛthulabhāvam āpannā piccitā nāma anāsāditamantayoś ca bahuśaḥ | kuṭṭitākuṭṭitā nāma śītabhasmamūrcchābhir apravṛttaśoṇitā aprasrūtā nāma tīkṣṇamahāmukhaśastraviddhā anudīrṇṇā nāma alparaktasrāvinyanteviddhā nāma| kṣīṇaśoṇitānilapūrṇṇāpariśuṣkā nāma | caturthabhāgamāsāditā kiñcitpravṛttaśoṇitākūṇitā nāma | dutthānabandhodveṣiṇyāśoṇitasaṃmoho bhavati | sā vepitā nāma | anusthitāyām apyevamaśastrakṛtyā avyadhyā nāma | chitvāt ipravṛttaśoṇitā kriyāsaṃgrahakarī śastrahatā nāma | tiryakpraṇihitaśastrākiñciccheṣātiryagviddhā nāma | bahuśaḥ kṣatā hīnaśastrapraṇidhānenāviddhā nāma | anavasthitaviddhā vidrutā nāma | vyadhapradeśasya bahuśovaghaṭṭanādasaṃārohamāṇavyadhā raktasrāvinyatyarthaṃ dhenukā nāma | punaḥ punaḥ praṇidhānā sirāmarmmasnāyvasthisaṃdhiṣu viddhā rujāśophau vaikalyam maraṇam vā bhavati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add A₁₉₃₁°straviddhā+avyaktamasṛk A₁₉₃₁sravatirujāśophavatī ca A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁add praviśati A₁₉₃₁śoṇitāti° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁kuñcitāyāmapyevaṃ, A₁₉₃₁°tā pṛthulībhāvamāpannā A₁₉₃₁anāsāditā punaḥ punarantayoś A₁₉₃₁add śastrābhihatā A₁₉₃₁om kuṭṭitā° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁śītabhayamū° A₁₉₃₁°tā'prasrutā, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°ddhā'tyudīrṇā, A₁₉₃₁alparaktasrāviṇyante° A₁₉₃₁ante 'bhihatā A₁₉₃₁kṣīṇaśoṇitasyānilapūrṇā pa° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁caturbhāgā(ca)sā° A₁₉₃₁°tā kūṇitā, A₁₉₃₁om Hdutthānabandhodvepiṇyā° A₁₉₃₁duḥsthānabandhanādvepamānāyāḥ śo° A₁₉₃₁anutthitaviddhāyāmapyevaṃ, A₁₉₃₁chinnā'tipra° A₁₉₃₁kriyāsaṅgakarī A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°strā kiṃciccheṣā tiryagviddhā, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°nāpaviddhā, A₁₉₃₁add aśastrakṛtyā A₁₉₃₁avyadhyā, ana° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om vyadha° A₁₉₃₁bahuśo 'vaghaṭṭanādārohadvyadhā A₁₉₃₁add muhurmuhurḥ A₁₉₃₁śoṇitasrāvā A₁₉₃₁add su kṣmaśastravyadhanādbahuśo A₁₉₃₁bhinnā A₁₉₃₁punarviddhā, A₁₉₃₁māṃsasnāyvasthisirāsandhimarmasu A₁₉₃₁rujāṃ śophaṃ A₁₉₃₁cāpādayati ||
1931 ed. 3.8.20 bhavanti cātra || sirāsuśikṣito nāsti calāhyetāḥ svabhāvataḥ | matsyavat parivarttante tasmād yatnena tāḍayet ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁sirāsu śi° A₁₉₃₁calā hyetāḥ
1931 ed. 3.8.21 ajānatā gṛhīte tu śastre kāyanipātite | bhavanti vyāpadastv etā bahavaś cāpy upadravāḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁vyāpadaścaitā
1931 ed. 3.8.22 snehādibhiḥ kriyāyogair nna tathā lepanair api | yāṃty āśu vyādhayaḥ śāntiṃ yathā samyak sirāvyadhāt ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁kriyāyogairna A₁₉₃₁yāntyāśu
1931 ed. 3.8.23 sirāvyadhaṃ cikitsārthaṃ śalyatantre vidhīyate | yathā samyak praṇihitā vastiḥ kāyacikitsite ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁sirāvyadhaścikitsārdhaṃ A₁₉₃₁prakīrtitaḥ || A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁praṇihitaḥ A₁₉₃₁samyagbastiḥ A₁₉₃₁°kitsate ||
1931 ed. 3.8.24 tatra snigdhasvinnavāntaviriktānuvāsitāsthāpitaviddhasirair mmanuṣyaiḥ pariharttavyāni || krodhāyāsamaithunadivāsvapnoccairbbhāṣyavyāyāmayānāsanānisthānacaṃkramaṇaśītavātātapaciruddhāsātmyājīrṇṇānyācalalābhātmāsameke manyante | vistaram eṣām upariṣṭād vakṣyāmaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°ktāsthāpitānuvāsitasirāviddhaiḥ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°ni---krodhāyāsamaithuna-divāsvapnavāgvyāyāmayānādhyayavasthānāsanacaṅkramaṇaśītavātātapaviruddhāsātmyājīrṇānyābalalābhāt , māsameke A₁₉₃₁add eteśāṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°ṣṭādvakṣyāmaḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.8.25 bhavati cātra || sirāviṣāṇatumbībhir jjalaukābhiḥ padais tathā | avagāḍhaṃ yathāpūrvvaṃ kriyate duṣṭaśoṇitaṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁bhavataś A₁₉₃₁°tumbais A₁₉₃₁add tu A₁₉₃₁nirharedduṣṭa°
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add avagāḍhe jalaukāḥ syāt pracchānaṃ piṇḍite hitam || sirā'ṅgavyāpake rakte śṛṅgālābū tvaci sthite ||

iti śārīre 'ṣṭamo 'dhyāyaḥ ||

[Adhyāya 9. Draft based on MS H]

1931 ed. 3.9.1 athāto dhamanīvyākaraṇaṃ śārīraṃ vyākhyāsyāmaḥ ||
K, N, L
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add yathovāca bhagavān dhanvantariḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.9.3 caturvviṃśatir ddhamanyo bhavanti | tās tu nābhiprabhavāḥ | tatra kecid āhur ācāryāḥ | sirāmanīsrotasāmavibhāgaḥ | sirāvikārā eva hi dhamanyaḥ srotānsi ceti | tat tu na samyagatrocyate | anyā eva hi dhamanyaḥ srotānsi sirāśceti | kasmād vyañjanānyatvāt mūlasanniyamāt karmmavaiśeṣyād āgamāc ca | kevalaṃ tu parasparapratānasannikarṣāt sadṛśakarmmatvāt saukṣmyāc ca vibhaktakarmmaṇām apyavibhāga eva karmmasu bhati |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°śatirdhamanyo A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°bhavā abhihitāḥ | A₁₉₃₁kecidāhuḥ---sirādhama° A₁₉₃₁srotāṃsi A₁₉₃₁samyak, A₁₉₃₁srotāṃsi A₁₉₃₁add ca A₁₉₃₁sirābhyaḥ; A₁₉₃₁vyañjanānyatvānmū° A₁₉₃₁°ṣyādāgamācca; A₁₉₃₁parasparasan° A₁₉₃₁sadṛśāgamaka° A₁₉₃₁saukṣmyācca A₁₉₃₁°rmaṇāmapyavibhāga A₁₉₃₁iva A₁₉₃₁bhavati ||
1931 ed. 3.9.4 tāsāṃ khalu nābhiprabhavānām ūrddhagā daśa daśa cādhogāminyaś catasras tiryaggāḥ |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add tu A₁₉₃₁°vāṇāṃ A₁₉₃₁dhamanīnāmūrdhvagā A₁₉₃₁catasrastiryaggāḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.9.5 ūrddhvagāḥ | khaluśabdasparśarūparasagandhapraśvāsocchvāsaprakṣitajṛmbhitahasitakathitaruditādīn viśeṣān abhivahantyaḥ śarīran dhārayanti | tās tu hṛdayam abhiprapannās tridhā tridhā jāyante | tāstriṃśat tāsāṃ tu vātapittaśleṣmaśoṇitarasān dve dve vahatastā daśa | śabdasparśarūparasagandhān aṣṭābhir gṛ hīte | dvābhyāṃ bhāṣate dvābhyāṃ ghoṣaṃ karoti | dvābhyāṃ svapiti dvābhyāṃ prativudhyate | dve asravāhinyo dve stanyas triyā vahataḥ stanasaṃśritā | eva śukraṃ nara sya stanayor abhivahatas tās tv etās triṃśat savibhāgā vyākhyātāḥ | etābhir ūrddhvan nābher udarapārśvapṛṣṭhoraḥ skandhagrīvāśīrṣavāhavo dhāryante yāpyante ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁śabdasparśarūparasagandhapraśvāsocchvāsajṛmbhitakṣuddhasitakathitaruditādīnviśeṣānabhi° A₁₉₃₁śarīraṃ Htāstu A₁₉₃₁hṛdayamabhiprapannāstridhā A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁vātapittakaphaśo° A₁₉₃₁śabdarūparasagandhānaṣṭābhir A₁₉₃₁gṛhṇīte, A₁₉₃₁pratibudhyate, A₁₉₃₁cāśruvāhiṇyau, A₁₉₃₁stanyaṃ A₁₉₃₁striyā A₁₉₃₁°śrite, A₁₉₃₁add te A₁₉₃₁narasya A₁₉₃₁stanābhyāmabhi° A₁₉₃₁tāstvetāstriṃśat A₁₉₃₁ūrdhvaṃ A₁₉₃₁nābherudarapārśvapṛṣṭhoraḥskandhagrīvābāhavo A₁₉₃₁add ca ||
1931 ed. 3.9.6 bhavati cātra ||
K, N, L
1931 ed. 3.9.11 pañcādhibhūtās tv atha pañcakṛtvaḥ pañcendriyam pañcādha bhāvayanti |
pañcendriyaṃ pañcādha bhāvayitvā paṃcatvam āyānti vināśakāle ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁pañcābhibhūtāstvatha A₁₉₃₁pañcasu A₁₉₃₁pañcasu A₁₉₃₁pañcatvamāyānti
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add ūrdhvaṃgamā(tā)stu kurvanti karmāṇy etāni sarvaśaḥ || adhogamās tu vakṣyāmi karma tāsāṃ yathāyatham ||
1931 ed. 3.9.7 adho gatāmās tu vātamūtrapurīṣaśukrārttavān abhivahanti | tās tu pittāśayam abhiprapannās tatrasthām annapānarasam abhipakvam auṣṇād vivecayantyo 'bhivahantyas tarpayanti || ūrddhvagānān tiryaggānāñ ca rasasthānāñcābhipūrayanti | tatra mūtrapurīṣasvedām̐ś ca vivecayaṃty āmapakvāśayāntare tridhā tridhā prajāyante tāṃs triśat | tāsān tu vātapittakaphaśoṇitarasān dve dve vahatas tā daśa | dve annavāhinyau | antrāsrite toyavaha dve dve mūtravastim abhiprapanne | śukraprādurvbhāvāya ca dve | evaṃ raktam abhivahate | nārīṇām ārttavasaṃjñe dve | varccāniḥsarataḥ sthūlāntraprativaddhe dve | aṣṭāv anyas tiryaggās tāḥ khedam arppayanti | tāstvetās triṃśat saṃvibhāgā vyākhyātāḥ | tābhir adho nābheḥ pakvāsayakaṭīmūtravastigudameḍhrasakthīni dhāryante |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁adhogamāstu Htuvā° A₁₉₃₁°vādīnyadho vahanti | A₁₉₃₁, Htāstu A₁₉₃₁pittāśayamabhipra(ti)pannāstatrasthamevānna° A₁₉₃₁vipakvamauṣṇyādvive(re)ca° A₁₉₃₁add śarīraṃ A₁₉₃₁add arpayanti A₁₉₃₁cordhvagānāṃ A₁₉₃₁tiryaggāṇāṃ A₁₉₃₁rasasthānaṃ cā° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°dāṃś A₁₉₃₁vive(re)ca° A₁₉₃₁ca A₁₉₃₁om pra° A₁₉₃₁tāstriṃśat; A₁₉₃₁tāsāṃ A₁₉₃₁vahatastā A₁₉₃₁'nnavāhinyāvantrāśrite, A₁₉₃₁toyavahe A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁mūtrabastimabhi° A₁₉₃₁add mūtravahe dve, śukravahe dve A₁₉₃₁°durbhāvāya, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁add visargāya, te A₁₉₃₁eva A₁₉₃₁raktamabhivahato (visṛjataśca) A₁₉₃₁nārīṇāmārtavasaṃjñaṃ, A₁₉₃₁varconirasanyau A₁₉₃₁°tibaddhe, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁aṣṭāvanyāstiryaggāṇāṃ A₁₉₃₁dhamanīnāṃ A₁₉₃₁svedamarpa° A₁₉₃₁tāstvetāstriṃśat A₁₉₃₁savi° A₁₉₃₁etābhir A₁₉₃₁adhovābheḥ A₁₉₃₁pakvāśayakaṭīmūtrapurīṣagudabastime° A₁₉₃₁add yāpyante ca ||
1931 ed. 3.9.8 bhavati cātra ||
K, N, L
1931 ed. 3.9.8.1 adhogatāmās tu kurvvanti karmmāṇy etāni sarvvaśaḥ |
tiryaggās tveva vakṣyāmi karmma cāsāṃ yathātathaṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁adhogamās A₁₉₃₁karmaṇy A₁₉₃₁saṃprava° A₁₉₃₁yathāyatham ||
1931 ed. 3.9.9 tiryaggānāṃ tu catasṛṇām ekaikā śatadhā sahasradhā ca bhidyante | tāstvasaṃkhyeyā tābhir idaṃ śarīraṃ gavākṣitaṃ vivaddham ātatañ ca tāsāñ ca sukhāni romakūpaprativaddhāni yaiḥ sveda prasravati rasaś cābhis antarppayati | antarvvahiś ca tābhieva cābhyaṃgapariśekāvagāhāvalepanavīryāṇyantaḥ śarīram abhiprapadyante | tvacivipakvāni tābhir eva ca sparśaśubhamaśubham vā gṛhīte tāś catasro dhamanyaḥ sarvvāṅgagatāḥ savibhāgā vyākhyātāḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁tiryaggāṇāṃ A₁₉₃₁dhamanīnāmekaikā A₁₉₃₁cottarottaraṃ A₁₉₃₁vibhajyante, A₁₉₃₁°khyeyāḥ, A₁₉₃₁vibaddhamātataṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁mukhāni A₁₉₃₁°tibaddhāni, A₁₉₃₁svedamabhivahanti A₁₉₃₁rasaṃ A₁₉₃₁cābhitarpayantyantarbahiśca , A₁₉₃₁tair eva A₁₉₃₁°riṣekāvagāhālepanavīryāṇyantaḥśarīramabhipratipadyante A₁₉₃₁tvaci vi° A₁₉₃₁tair A₁₉₃₁sparśaṃ sukhamasukhaṃ A₁₉₃₁gṛhṇāti; A₁₉₃₁tāstvetāścatasro Htāścatasro
1931 ed. 3.9.10 bhavataś cātra ślokau ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.9.10.0 dhamanyaḥ sarvve evās tāḥ pratibaddhā yathendriyaṃ |
jāgratāṃ svapatām vāpi vahatā īndriyagocare ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L Hvahatāīṃndri°
1931 ed. 3.9.10.1 yathā svabhāvataḥ khāni mṛṇāleṣu viśeṣu ca |
tathaiva tāsāṃ dvārāṇi raso yair upacīyate ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁biseṣu A₁₉₃₁dhamanīnāṃ A₁₉₃₁tathā A₁₉₃₁svāni
1931 ed. 3.9.12 ata ūrddhvaṃ srotasāṃ mūlaṃ viddhalakṣaṇaṃ vyākhyāsyāmaḥ | tāni tu prāṇān nodakarasaraktamāṃsamedomūtrapurīṣaśukrārttavavahāni yeṣv adhīkāraḥ | eṣāṃ viśeṣāvahavaḥ | teṣāṃ mūlaṃ dayaṃ rasavahinyaś ca dhamanyas tatra viddhasya krośanavinamanabhramaṇāni saṃjñānāśo maraṇañ ca | annavahe dve tayor mmūlamāmāsayonnavāhinyaś ca dhamanyaḥ | tatra viddasya prāṇavahaviddhavat maraṇaṃ | talliṅgaś ca raktavahe dve tayor mūlaṃ yakṛtplīhānau tatra viddhasya śyāvāṅgatā jvaraḥ pāṇḍutādāhaṛ śoṇitābhigamanañ ca | mānsavahe dve tayor mmūlaṃ snāyustvagraktavahāś ca nāḍyas tatra viddhasya śvayathur mmāṃsaśoṣaḥ śirāgranthayor mmaraṇañ ca | medovahe dve tayor mmūlaṃ kaṭīvṛkkau ca tatra viddhasya svedāgamanaṃ snigdhāṅgan tāluśoṣaś ca | mūtravahe dve tayor mmūlaṃ vastimeḍhrañ ca | tatra viddhasyānaddhavastitā mūtranirodhastavdhameḍhratā ca | purīṣavahe dve tayor mmūlam pakvāśayo gudaś ca tatra viddhasyānāho durggandhatāgrathitāntratā ca | śukravahe dve tayor mmūlaṃ stanau vṛṣaṇau ca | tatra viddhasya klaivyaṃ cirād vā pra sekaḥ praseke cālpaśukradarśanaṃ | sevanīcchedā pradurvbhāvo maraṇañ ca | srotoviddhan tu pratyākhyāyopakrameta | uddhṛtaśalyaṃ tu kṣatavidhānenopakramed iti |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁mūlavi° A₁₉₃₁upadekṣyāmaḥ | A₁₉₃₁prāṇānno° A₁₉₃₁avikāraḥ; A₁₉₃₁ekeṣāṃ A₁₉₃₁add bahūni; eteṣāṃ A₁₉₃₁viśeṣā bahavaḥ | A₁₉₃₁tatra A₁₉₃₁add prāṇavahe dve, tayor A₁₉₃₁hṛdayaṃ A₁₉₃₁rasavāhinyaśca A₁₉₃₁viddhyasya A₁₉₃₁°namohanabhramaṇavepanāni A₁₉₃₁add maraṇaṃ vā A₁₉₃₁bhavati; annavahe dve, tayor mūlamāmāśayo 'nnavāhinyś A₁₉₃₁add ca dhamanyaḥ, A₁₉₃₁tatra viddhasyādhmānaṃ A₁₉₃₁śūlānnadveṣau chardiḥpipāsā 'ndhyaṃ maraṇaṃ ca; udakavahe A₁₉₃₁add mūlaṃ tālu kloma ca, tatra viddhasya pipasā sadyomaraṇaṃ ca; rasavahe dve, tayor A₁₉₃₁mūlaṃ hṛdayaṃ rasavā° A₁₉₃₁viddhasya A₁₉₃₁add śoṣaḥ A₁₉₃₁°vac A₁₉₃₁add ca A₁₉₃₁talliṅgāni A₁₉₃₁add raktavāhinyaś ca dhamanyaḥ, A₁₉₃₁add dāhaḥ A₁₉₃₁pāṇḍutā A₁₉₃₁śoṇitāga° A₁₉₃₁add raktanetratā A₁₉₃₁māṃsavahe A₁₉₃₁snāyutvacaṃ rakta° A₁₉₃₁dhamanyaḥ, A₁₉₃₁śvayathurmāṃsa° A₁₉₃₁sirāgranthayo A₁₉₃₁kaṭī vṛkkau A₁₉₃₁snigdhāṅgatā A₁₉₃₁add sthūlaśophatā pipāsā A₁₉₃₁bastirmeḍhraṃ A₁₉₃₁°ddhabastitā A₁₉₃₁°rodhaḥ stabdhamiḍhratā A₁₉₃₁gudaṃ A₁₉₃₁durgandhatā gra° A₁₉₃₁klībatā A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁praseko A₁₉₃₁raktaśukratā ca; ārtavavahe dve, tayor mūlaṃ garbhāśaya ārtavavāhinyaś ca dhamanyaḥ, tatra viddhāyā vandhyātvaṃ A₁₉₃₁add maithunāsahiṣṇutvamārtavanāśaśca; A₁₉₃₁°dādrujāprādurbhāvaḥ; A₁₉₃₁bastigudaviddhalakṣaṇaṃ A₁₉₃₁prāguktam iti | A₁₉₃₁srotoviddhaṃ A₁₉₃₁°pacaret, A₁₉₃₁°pacaret || A₁₉₃₁om
13.2 ślokau ||
ya evaṃ na prajānāti srotasām mūlaniścayaṃ |
mahadbhayam avāpnoti na sa karmmasu siddhyati ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L
13.3 yaḥ samyag etaṃ jānīyāt sa bhaved rājasammataḥ |
pūjārho bhiṣajāṃ hy eṣa iti dhanvantarer mataṃ ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L

iti dhamanīvyākaraṇaṃ śārīrannavamodhyāyaḥ ||

1931 ed. 3.10.1 || athāto garvbhiṇīvyākaraṇaṃ śārīram vyākhyāsyāmaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁garbhiṇī°
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add yathovāca bhagavān dhanvantariḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.10.3 tatra garbhiṇīm prathamadivasāt prabhṛtyādi sennityaṃ hṛṣṭaśucyalaṃkṛtavāsasā śāntimaṅgaladevatābrāhmaṇaguruparā ca bhavitavyaṃ | malinavikṛtahīnagātrāṇi ca na spṛśet | durggandhadurddaśanāni ca dūrata eva pariharet | vahin nniḥkṛṭāśūnyāgāracaity aśmaśānacaity avṛkṣasevāś ca krodhāyāsakarāṃś ca bhāvān uccair bhāṣyādikaṃ ca pariharet | udvejanīyāś ca kathāḥ śuṣkam paryuṣitaṃ kuthitaṃ klinnaṃ cānnanopayuñjīta yāni ca garbham vyāpādayanti | na ca tailābhyaṅgotsā danādīni niśeveta | na cāyāsayeccharīraṃ pūrvvoktāni ca pariharet | śayanāsanañ ca samṛddhās taraṇaṃ nātyucchritam apāśrayopetam asaṃvādham vidadhyāt | hṛdyaṃ dravamadhuraprāyasnigdhan dīpanīyaṃ saṃskṛtabhojanañ ca bhojayet sāmānyam etad ā prasavakālāt |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁garbhiṇī Hgarvbhiṇīm A₁₉₃₁prabhṛti A₁₉₃₁nityaṃ A₁₉₃₁prahṛṣṭā śuvyalaṅkṛtā śuklavasanā A₁₉₃₁bhavet, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°rdarśanāni A₁₉₃₁add pariharet, udvejanīyāś A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁kathāḥ, śuṣkaṃ A₁₉₃₁paryuṣitaṃ A₁₉₃₁add kuthitaṃ klinnaṃ cānnaṃ nopabhuñjīta, A₁₉₃₁bahirniṣkramaṇaṃ śūnyāgāracaityaśmaśānavṛkṣāśrayān A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁krodhabhayasaṅka° Hvbhāṣyā° A₁₉₃₁om Hgarvbham A₁₉₃₁cābhīkṣṇaṃ A₁₉₃₁°tsādanādīni A₁₉₃₁niṣeveta, A₁₉₃₁pariharet, śaya° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁mṛdv A₁₉₃₁āstaraṇaṃ A₁₉₃₁nātyuccam A₁₉₃₁asaṃbādhaṃ A₁₉₃₁add ca A₁₉₃₁dravae madhuraprāyaṃ snigdhaṃ A₁₉₃₁dīpanīyasaṃskṛtaṃ ca bho° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁āprasavāt ||
1931 ed. 3.10.4 viśeṣatas tu garvbhiṇī prathamadvitīyatṛtīyeṣu māseṣu madhuraśītadravaprāyamāhāramā āseveta | caturthe māse payo navanītam āhāram āharet | pañcame kṣīrasarppiḥ saṃsṛṣṭaṃ | ṣaṣṭhe svadaṃṣṭrāsiddhasya sarppiṣā pakṣamātraṃ yuktyā yavāgūm pāyayet | saptame pṛthak parṇyādisiddham evam āpyāyyate garbhaḥ | aṣṭame khalvenāṃ vadarodakena valātivalāpayodadhimas tu tailamadhughṛtaśatapuṣpāmiśreṇāsthāpayet purāṇapurīṣaśuddhyartham anulomārthañ ca vāyos tataḥ payo madhurasiddhena tailenānuvāsayet | anulome hi vāyau sukham prasūyate | nirupadravāś ca bhavanti | ata ūrddhvaṃ snigdhābhir yavāgūbhir jjāṅgalarasaiś copahared ā prasavakālāt | evam upakrāntāsnigdhāvalavatīsukham anupadravā prasūyate |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁garbhiṇī A₁₉₃₁°tīyamāseṣu A₁₉₃₁°hāram A₁₉₃₁upaseveta, A₁₉₃₁add viśeṣatas tu tṛtīye ṣaṣṭikaudanaṃ payasā A₁₉₃₁bhojayeccaturthe A₁₉₃₁add dadhnā A₁₉₃₁pañcame A₁₉₃₁add payasā ṣaṣṭhe sarpiṣā cetyeke, caturthe A₁₉₃₁payonavanītasaṃsṛṣṭamāhārayejjāṅgalamāṃsasahitaṃ A₁₉₃₁add hṛdyam annaṃ A₁₉₃₁bhojayet , A₁₉₃₁°rpiḥsaṃsṛṣṭaṃ , A₁₉₃₁śvaśvadaṃ° A₁₉₃₁sarpiṣo mātrāṃ A₁₉₃₁pāyayed A₁₉₃₁vā, A₁₉₃₁add sarpiḥ A₁₉₃₁pṛthakparṇyā° A₁₉₃₁āpyāyate Hgarvbhaḥ | A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁bada° A₁₉₃₁balātibalāśatapuṣpāpalalapayodadhimastutailalavaṇamadanaphalamadhughṛtami° A₁₉₃₁anulomanārthaṃ A₁₉₃₁payomadhurakaṣāyasi° A₁₉₃₁°dravā A₁₉₃₁bhavati, A₁₉₃₁yavāgbhir A₁₉₃₁jāṅgalarasaiścopakramedāpra° A₁₉₃₁upakrāntā snigdhā balavatī sukhamanu°
1931 ed. 3.10.5 navame māsi sūtikāgāram enāṃ praveśayet | praśaste tithyādau | tatreṣṭāgāraṃ brāhmaṇakṣattriyavaiśyaśūdrāṇāṃ śvetaraktakṛṣṇeṣu bhūmipradeśeṣu | vilvanyagrodhatindukanirmmitaṃ sarvvāgāran tat mayañ ca paryavanaddhaṃ samupaliptabhittiparicchadaṃ prāgdvāram udagdvāram vāṣṭahastāyata caturhastavistṛtaṃ rakṣāmaṃgalasampannam vidheyaṃ |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°gāramenāṃ A₁₉₃₁praśastati° A₁₉₃₁tatrāriṣṭaṃ A₁₉₃₁°ktapītakṛṣṇeṣu A₁₉₃₁bilvanyagrodhatindukabhallātaka° A₁₉₃₁sarvāgāraṃ A₁₉₃₁yathāsaṅkhyaṃ A₁₉₃₁tanmayaparyaṅkam A₁₉₃₁upaliptabhittiṃ suvibhaktapa° A₁₉₃₁kakṣiṇadvāraṃ A₁₉₃₁vā 'ṣṭahastāyataṃ
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add jāte hi śithile kukṣau mukte hṛdayabandhane || saśūle jaghane vārī jñeyā sā tu prajāyinī ||
1931 ed. 3.10.7 tatropasthitaprasavāyāḥ kaṭīpṛṣṭhaṃ pratisamantād vedanā bhavati | mūtramabhīkṣṇam prasicyate | yonimukhāc ca śleṣmā
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁prati sa° A₁₉₃₁abhīkṣṇaṃ A₁₉₃₁add purīṣapravṛttir mūtraṃ A₁₉₃₁°khāc chleṣmā A₁₉₃₁add ca ||
1931 ed. 3.10.8 prajāyiṣyamāṇāṃ tusvabhyaktām uṣṇodakapariṣiktagātrīṅ kṛtamaṅgalāmathenāṃ sa ghṛtāṃ yavāgūṃ kaṇṭhāt pītavatī mṛduni kṛtopadhānavistīrṇṇe śayane sthitāmābhugnasakthinīmuttānām aśaṅkanīyās tisraś catasraḥ pariṇatavayasaḥ | vrajananakuśalāḥ kalpitanakhyaḥ paricareyuriti ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁prajanayi° A₁₉₃₁add kṛtamaṅgalasvastivācanāṃ kumāraparivṛtāṃ A₁₉₃₁punnāmaphalahastāṃ svabhyaktāmuṣṇodakapariṣiktāmathaināṃ A₁₉₃₁sambhṛtāṃ A₁₉₃₁yavāgūmākaṇ° A₁₉₃₁pāyayet, tataḥ A₁₉₃₁°dhāne mṛduni vistīrṇe A₁₉₃₁°sakthīmuttānāmaśaṅkanīyāścatasraḥ A₁₉₃₁striyaḥ A₁₉₃₁praja° A₁₉₃₁kartitanakhāḥ A₁₉₃₁°reyur iti ||
1931 ed. 3.10.9 athāsyā viśikhāntaramanulomāyām anusukhamabhyaṃjyāt | vrūyāc cainām etāḥ subhage pravāhayaśceti | mā cāprāptāvīḥ pravāhiṣṭhāḥ | anāgatā svāviṣu pravāhamāṇāḥ | vadhiraṃ mūkaṃ srastahanuṃ mūrddhābhighātinaṃ kāsaśvāsaśoṣopadrutaṃ kuvjaṃ vikaṭam vā janayati |tasmād anāgatāvī na pravāheta | sraste tu kukṣau vimukte garbhanāḍī pravandhe samūle śroṇīvaṃkṣaṇavastiśiraḥ supravāheta śanaiḥ śanais tato garbhayonimukhaṃ prapannagāḍhataram āviśalyabhāvāt |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°lomam-asunukhamabhyajyānubrūyāc A₁₉₃₁caināmikā A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁pravāhasveti, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁nacāprāptāvī A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁pravāhasva, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁tato A₁₉₃₁om Hgarvbhanāḍī A₁₉₃₁°ḍīprabandhe A₁₉₃₁saśūleṣu A₁₉₃₁śroṇivaṅkṣaṇabastiśiraḥsu A₁₉₃₁ca pravāhethāḥ A₁₉₃₁add (pūrvaṃ ), A₁₉₃₁add garbhanirgame pragāḍhaṃ, tato Hgarvbhayo° A₁₉₃₁garbhe yo° A₁₉₃₁prapanne gāḍhataramāvi° A₁₉₃₁add akālapravāhaṇādbadhiraṃ mūkaṃ kubjaṃ vyastahanumūrdhvābhighātinaṃ kāsaśvāsaśoṣopadrutaṃ vikaṭaṃ vā janayati ||
1931 ed. 3.10.10 tatra pratilom anupānaṃ pāyayet śosayet |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁pratilomam A₁₉₃₁anulomayet ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add garbhasaṅge tu yoniṃ dhūpayet kṛṣṇasarpanirmokeṇa piṇḍītakena vā, badhnīyād dhiraṇyapuṣpīmūlaṃ hastapādayoḥ, dhārayet suvarcalāṃ viśalyāṃ vā ||
1931 ed. 3.10.12 jātasyolvaṃ viśodhyāsyaṃ saindhavasarppiṣāṣṭāṃgulāvaśeṣāṃ nāḍīm vaddhayitvā kuṣṭhatailenābhyajya sūtreṇāvaddhya kumārasya grīvāyām vadhnīyāt |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add atha A₁₉₃₁jātasyolbamapanīya , A₁₉₃₁mukhaṃ A₁₉₃₁add ca A₁₉₃₁°ṣā A₁₉₃₁add viśodhya, ghṛtāktaṃ A₁₉₃₁add mūrdhni A₁₉₃₁picuṃ A₁₉₃₁dadyāt; A₁₉₃₁tato nābhivāḍīmaṣṭāṅgulam āyamya A₁₉₃₁sūtreṇa baddhvā A₁₉₃₁add chedayet, tat sūtraikadeśaṃ ca A₁₉₃₁add samyag A₁₉₃₁badhnī°
1931 ed. 3.10.13 atha kumāraṃ śītābhir adbhir āśvāsya jātakarmmaṇi madhusarppiranantāmiśraṃ vrahmīrasena suvarṇṇamaṅgulyā nāsikayā lehayet | sūtikāñ ca ghṛtatailayor anyatarasya mātrāṃ pipalyādi kaṣāyam anupānam pāyayet | valavatīm avalāṃ yavāgūn trirātram pañcarātram vā || ata ūrddhvaṃ snigdhenānnasaṃsarggeṇopacaret snehanity ā ca syāt |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add kṛte A₁₉₃₁°nantacūrṇam A₁₉₃₁aṅgulyā A₁₉₃₁'nāmikayā A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁tato A₁₉₃₁balātailenābhyajya, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁kṣīravṛkṣakaṣāyeṇa A₁₉₃₁sarvagandhodakena A₁₉₃₁add A₁₉₃₁rūpyahemaprataptena A₁₉₃₁ A₁₉₃₁vāriṇā snāpayed enaṃ A₁₉₃₁kapitthapatrakaṣāyeṇa A₁₉₃₁add koṣṇena A₁₉₃₁yathākālaṃ A₁₉₃₁add yathādoṣaṃ A₁₉₃₁yathāvibhavaṃ A₁₉₃₁om
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add dhamanīnāṃ hṛdisthānāṃ vivṛtatvād anantaram || catūrātrāt trirātrād vā strīṇāṃ stanyaṃ pravartate ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add tasmāt prathame 'hni madhusarpir-anantamiśraṃ mantrapūtaṃ trikālaṃ pāyayet, dvitīye lakṣmaṇāsiddhaṃ sarpiḥ, tṛtīye ca; tataḥ prāṅgivāritastanyaṃ madhusarpiḥ svapāṇitalasaṃmitaṃ dvikālaṃ pāyayet ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add atha sūtikāṃ balātailābhyaktāṃ vātaharauṣadhaniṣkvāthenopacaret | saśeṣadoṣāṃ tu tad ahaḥ pippalīpippalīmūlahastipippalīcitrakaśṛṅgaveracūrṇaṃ guḍodakenoṣṇena pāyayet, evaṃ dvirātraṃ trirātraṃ vā kuryād āduṣṭaśoṇitāt | viśuddhe tato vidārigandhādisiddhāṃ snehayavāgūṃ kṣīrayavāgūṃ vā pāyayet trirātram | tato yavakolakulatthasiddhena śālyodanaṃ bhojayed balam agnibalaṃ cāvekṣya | anena vidhinā 'dhyardhamāsam upasaṃskṛtā vimuktāhārācārā vigatasūtikābhidhānā syāt, punar ārtavadarśanād ity eke ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add dhavvabhūmijātāṃ tu sūtikāṃ ghṛtatailayor anyatarasya mātrāṃ pāyayet pippalyādikaṣāyānupānāṃ, snehan ity ā ca syāt trirātraṃ pañcarātraṃ vā (balavatī ;) abalāṃ yavāgūṃ pāyayet trirātraṃ pañcarātraṃ vā | ata ūrdhvaṃ snigdhenānnasaṃsargeṇopacaret ||
1931 ed. 3.10.18 prāyaścainām prabhūtenoṣṇodakena pariṣiñcet krodhāyāsamaithunādīm̐ś ca pariharet ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁prāyaśaś caināṃ A₁₉₃₁°dīn
1931 ed. 3.10.19 bhavati cātra ||
mithyācārāt sūtikāyā yovyādhirupajāyate |
sa kṛcchrasādhyo 'sādhyo vā bhaveddhātvapakarṣarṇāt ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁bhavataś A₁₉₃₁yo vyā° A₁₉₃₁bhaved atyapatarpaṇāt ||
1931 ed. 3.10.20 tasmāt tāṃ deśakālau tu vyādhisātmyena karmmaṇā |
parīkṣyopacaren nityam evaṃ nātyayam āpnuyāt ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁ca
1931 ed. 3.10.21 athāmarāmapatantīm pātayet kaṇṭham asyāḥkeśaveṣṭitayāṅgulyā pramṛśet kaṭukā lāvukṛtavedhanasarṣapasarppanirmmocakair vvā kuṭatailair yonim udrūpayet | lāṅgalakīmūlakalkena vāsyāḥ pāṇipādatalam ālimpet | kuṣṭhalāṅgalakīmūlakalkam vā madyamūtrayor anyatareṇa pāyayet | śālimūlakalkam vā pi ppalyādikalkam vā madyena | siddhārthakakuṣṭhailālāṅgalakīmahāvṛkṣakṣīrasurāmaṇḍairāsthāpayet | etaiṣveva ca siddhena siddhārthakatailenottaracūrṇṇavastiś cāsyai dadyāt | hastena cāpaharet |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁athāparā 'patanty A₁₉₃₁add ānāhādhmānau kurute, A₁₉₃₁tasmāt A₁₉₃₁kaṇṭhamasyāḥ keśaveṣṭitayā 'ṅgulyā A₁₉₃₁pramṛjet, A₁₉₃₁kaṭukālābukṛtavedhanasarṣapasarpanirmokair A₁₉₃₁kaṭutailavimiśrair A₁₉₃₁yonimukhaṃ A₁₉₃₁dhūpayet, A₁₉₃₁lāṅgalīmū° A₁₉₃₁vā 'syāḥ A₁₉₃₁add mūrdhni vā 'syā mahāvṛkṣakṣīram anusecayet, A₁₉₃₁kuṣṭhalāṅgalīmū° A₁₉₃₁pāyayet, śālamū° A₁₉₃₁pippalyādiṃ A₁₉₃₁°kuṣṭhalāṅgalīmahāvṛkṣakṣīramiśreṇa surāmaṇḍena vā 'sthāpayet, A₁₉₃₁etair eva A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°rabastiṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁add snigdhena vā A₁₉₃₁kṛttanakhena A₁₉₃₁hastenāpa°
1931 ed. 3.10.22 prajātāyās tu vastiśirodarayoniśūlaṃ raktaṃ saṃruddhya vāyuḥ karoti sa makkalaḥ | tatra yavakṣāracūrṇṇaṃ sarppiṣā sukhodakena pāyayet || lavaṇacūrṇṇam vā surāmaṇḍena | purāṇaguḍam vā trikaṭuka trijātakakustumvurumiśram vā khādayet | pṛthakparṇṇyādikvāthaṃ bhadradārumaricavacāsaṃsṛṣṭam pāyayet |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add ca nāryā A₁₉₃₁rukṣaśarīrāyāstīkṣṇair-aviśodhitaṃ A₁₉₃₁add vāyunā A₁₉₃₁taddeśagatenātisaṃruddhaṃ A₁₉₃₁add nābheradhaḥ A₁₉₃₁pārśvayor A₁₉₃₁add bastau bastiśirasi vā granthiṃ A₁₉₃₁tataś A₁₉₃₁add ca nābhibastyudaraśūlāni A₁₉₃₁bhavanti, sūcībhir A₁₉₃₁iva A₁₉₃₁add nistudyate bhidyate A₁₉₃₁add dīryata iva ca pakvāśayaḥ, samantādādhmānamudare mūtrasaṅgaś ca bhavatīti A₁₉₃₁makkallalakṣaṇam | A₁₉₃₁add tatra A₁₉₃₁sukhoṣṇena A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°cūrṇena A₁₉₃₁add vīratarvādisiddhaṃ A₁₉₃₁jalamuṣakādipratīvāpaṃ A₁₉₃₁add pāyayet, A₁₉₃₁yavakṣāracūrṇaṃ A₁₉₃₁pippalyādikvāthena, A₁₉₃₁add pippalyādicūrṇaṃ vā surāmaṇḍena, A₁₉₃₁varuṇādikvāthaṃ A₁₉₃₁pañcakolailāpratīvāpaṃ, A₁₉₃₁add A₁₉₃₁°casaṃsṛṣṭaṃ, A₁₉₃₁add purāṇaguḍaṃ vā A₁₉₃₁trikaṭukacaturjātakakustumburumuśraṃ khādet, A₁₉₃₁add acchaṃ vā pibed ariṣṭam iti ||
1931 ed. 3.10.23 atha vālaṃ kṣaumaparihitaṃ kṣaumakārppāsās tṛtāyāṃ śāyayīta | nimvapīluparuṣaka śākhābhiś cainaṃ parivījayet | mūrddhni cāsya tailapicum avatārayet | dhūpayec cainaṃ rakṣoghnaiddhūpaiḥ | rakṣoghnāni cāsya pāṇipādaśirogrīvāsvavasujet | tilātasīsarṣapakaṇāś cātra prakiret | adhiṣṭhāne cāgnim prajvālayet | vraṇitopāsanīyañ cāvekṣyeta
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁bālaṃ A₁₉₃₁°rivṛtaṃ A₁₉₃₁kṣaumavastrāstṛtāyāṃ A₁₉₃₁add śayyāyāṃ A₁₉₃₁śāyayet, A₁₉₃₁pīlubadarīnimbaparūṣakaśā° A₁₉₃₁cāsyāharahastaila° A₁₉₃₁avacāra° A₁₉₃₁rakṣoghnair dhūpaiḥ, A₁₉₃₁°vāsv avasṛjet, A₁₉₃₁°kaṇāṃś A₁₉₃₁cāvekṣeta ||
1931 ed. 3.10.24 tato daśamyāṃ mātāpitarau kṛtamaṅgalakautukau svastivācakapūrvvakaṃ nāma kuryāt āṃ | yathābhipretaṃ nakṣatran nāma vā |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁daśame A₁₉₃₁add 'hani A₁₉₃₁°canaṃ A₁₉₃₁add kṛtvā A₁₉₃₁yad abhi° A₁₉₃₁nakṣatranāma
1931 ed. 3.10.25 tato yathāvarṇṇaṃ dhātrīm upasthāpayet | kṛṣāmasthūlām vayaḥsthāmam avyādhitām prasannakṣīrāmavalamvorddhastanīm avyaṅgām avyasanaṃ nījīvavatsāṃvatsalāṃ dogdhīm akṣudrāṃkule jātamato bhūyiṣṭaiś ca guṇair anvitām ārogyavalavṛddhaye kumārasya | tatrātikṛṣātisthūlāninditā vyādhitāś ca vyākhyātās tāviṣamadhātutvād rogān āpādayanti vālasya viśeṣataḥ | ūrdhvastanī karālaṃ kumāraṃ kuryāl lamvastanī nāsikāmukhaṃ cchādayitvā maraṇam āpādayanti | atha praśastāṃ śirasnātā mahadvāsasām udaṅmukhīm upaveśya dakṣiṇaṃ stanaṃ kumāraṃ pūrvvam pāyayet || anena mantreṇābhimantrya ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁upeyān A₁₉₃₁add madhyamapramāṇāṃ A₁₉₃₁madhyamavayaskām A₁₉₃₁add arogāṃ A₁₉₃₁śīlavatīm A₁₉₃₁add acapalām alolupām akṛśām asthūlāṃ A₁₉₃₁°kṣīrām alambauṣṭhīm alambordhvastanīm A₁₉₃₁avyasaninīṃ jīvadvatsāṃ dogdhrīṃ va° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁akṣudrakarmiṇīṃ kule A₁₉₃₁jātāmato A₁₉₃₁bhūyiṣṭhaiś A₁₉₃₁add śyāmām A₁₉₃₁ārogyabala° A₁₉₃₁bālasya | A₁₉₃₁tatrordhva° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁kuryāt , A₁₉₃₁lambastanī A₁₉₃₁āpādayet | A₁₉₃₁tataḥ A₁₉₃₁praśastāyāṃ A₁₉₃₁add tithau A₁₉₃₁śiraḥsnātam A₁₉₃₁ahatavāsasam A₁₉₃₁udaṅmukhaṃ A₁₉₃₁add śiśum upaveśya dhātrīṃ prāṅmukhīm A₁₉₃₁dhautam A₁₉₃₁īṣatparisrutam A₁₉₃₁abhimantrya A₁₉₃₁mantreṇānena A₁₉₃₁add pāyayet ||
1931 ed. 3.10.26 catvāraḥ sāgarāḥ puṇyāḥ stanānāṃ kṣīravāhināṃ |
santu te śubhage nityaṃ vālasyānuvalapradāḥ |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁`ca° A₁₉₃₁tubhyaṃ A₁₉₃₁stanayoḥ A₁₉₃₁°hiṇaḥ | A₁₉₃₁bhavantu A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁subhage A₁₉₃₁bālasya A₁₉₃₁add balavṛddhaye ||
1931 ed. 3.10.27 piben vālomṛtarasaṃ payas tava śubhānane |
dīrgham āyur avāpnotu devāḥ prāśyāmṛtaṃ yathā ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁payo A₁₉₃₁'mṛtarasaṃpītvā A₁₉₃₁kumāras A₁₉₃₁te
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add ato 'nyathā nānāstanyopayogasyāsātmyād vyādhijanma bhavati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add aparisrute 'py atistabdhastanyapūrṇastanapānādutsuhitasrotasaḥ śiśoḥ kāsaśvāsavamī prādurbhāvaḥ | tasmād evaṃ vidhānāṃ stanyaṃ na pāyayet ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add krodhaśokāvātsalyādibhiś ca striyāḥ stanyanāśo bhavati | athāsyāḥ kṣīrajananārthaṃ saumanasyam utpādya yavagodhūmaśāliṣaṣṭikamāṃsarasasurāsauvīrakapiṇyākalaśunamatsyakaśerukaśṛṅgāṭakabisavidārikandamadhukaśatāvarīnalikālābūkālaśākaprabhṛtīni vidadhyāt ||
1931 ed. 3.10.31 athāsyāḥ kṣīrasañjananārthaṃ yavagodhūmaśāliṣaṣṭikamāṃsakṣīrasurāsauvīrapiṇyāka rasonamatsyakaśerukāśṛṅgāṭakavidārīkandaśatāvarīviśamṛṇālanālikālāvukālaśākaprabhṛtīni vidadhyāt | atha tasyāḥ stanyam apsu parīkṣeta tac cec chītalam amalaṃ tanuṃ śaṃkhāvabhāsaṃ apsu caikībhāvaṃ gacchaty aphenilam̐ matraṇḍulaṃ na plavate sīdati vā tac chuddham iti vindyāt | tena kumārasyārogyaṃ bhavati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om Htaccecchī° A₁₉₃₁tanu A₁₉₃₁nyastam ekī° HgacchatyaLphe° A₁₉₃₁aphenilam A₁₉₃₁atantum A₁₉₃₁annotplavate A₁₉₃₁'vasīdati A₁₉₃₁vidyāt, A₁₉₃₁add śarīropacayo balavṛddhiś ca A₁₉₃₁add na ca kṣudhitaśokārtaśrāntapraduṣṭadhātugarbhiṇījvaritātikṣīṇātisthūlavidagdhabhaktaviruddhāhāratarpitāyāḥ stanyaṃ pāyayet; nājīrṇauṣadhaṃ ca bālaṃ, doṣauṣadhamalānāṃ tīvravegotpattibhayāt ||
1931 ed. 3.10.32 bhavati cātra ||
dhātryās tu gurubhir bhojyair vviṣalais tathā |
doṣā dehe prakupyanti tata stanyam praduṣyati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁bhavanti A₁₉₃₁viṣamair A₁₉₃₁add doṣalais A₁₉₃₁tataḥ
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add mithyāhāravihāriṇya duṣṭā vātādayaḥ striyāḥ || dūṣayanti payas tena śārīrā vyādhayaḥ śiśoḥ || bhavanti kuśalas tāṃś ca bhiṣak samyag vibhāvayet ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add aṅgapratyaṅgadeśe tu rujā yatrāsya jāyate || muhurmuhuḥ spṛśati taṃ spṛśyamāne ca roditi ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add nimīlitākṣo mūrdhasthe śiro roge na dhārayet || bastis the mūtrasaṅgārto rujā tṛṣyati mūrcchati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add viṇmūtrasaṅgavaivarṇyacchardyādhmānāntrakūjanaiḥ || koṣṭhe doṣān vijānīyāt sarvatrasthāṃś ca rodanaiḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.10.37 duṣṭaṃprāguktan tena śarīrāvyādhayaḥ prādurbhavanti | teṣu ca yathābhihitaṃ mṛdvacchedanīyam auṣadham mātrayā kṣīrasya kṣīrasarppiḥ saṃyuktaṃ vidadhyāt | dhātryāś ca kevalaṃ | kṣīrānnād asya kalkī kṛtaṃ | dhātryāś ca pūrvvavat | annād asya kaṣāyādīnām ātmanyeva na dhātryāḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om Hprādurvbhavanti | A₁₉₃₁mṛdv acche° A₁₉₃₁kṣīrapasya A₁₉₃₁kṣīrasarpiṣā A₁₉₃₁vidadhyāt, A₁₉₃₁asyātmani A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁ca, annādasya A₁₉₃₁°dīn A₁₉₃₁ātmany eva
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add tatra māsādūrdhvaṃ kṣīrapāyāṅguliparvadvayagraha(ṇa)saṃmitāmauṣadhamātrāṃ vidadhyāt, kolāsthisaṃmitāṃ kalkamātrāṃ kṣīrānnādāya, kolasaṃmitāmannādāyeti ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add yeṣāṃ gadānāṃ ye yogāḥ pravakṣyante 'gadaṅkarāḥ || teṣu tat kalkasaṃliptau pāyayeta śiśuṃ stanau ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add ekaṃ dve trīṇi cāhāni vātapittakaphajvare || stanyapāyāhitaṃ sarpiritarābhyāṃ yathārthataḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add na ca tṛṣṇābhayād atra pāyayeta śiśuṃ stanau || virekabastivamanānyṛte kuryāc ca nātyayāt ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add mastuluṅgakṣayād yasya vāyus tālv asthi nāmayet || tasya tṛḍdainyayuktasya sarpirmadhurakaiḥ śṛtam ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add pānābhyañjanayor yojyaṃ śītāmbūdvejanaṃ tathā || vātenādhmāpitāṃ nābhiṃ sarujāṃ tuṇḍisaṃjñitām ||
1931 ed. 3.10.44 vālānāṃ gudapākeṣu pittaghnīṃ kārayet kriyāṃ |
rasāñjanam viśeṣeṇa pānālepanayorhitaṃ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add mārutaghnaiḥ praśamayet snehasvedopanāhanaiḥ || A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°ke tu A₁₉₃₁add bālānāṃ A₁₉₃₁°nayor hitam ||
1931 ed. 3.10.45 kṣīrāhārasya siddhārthakavacāpayasyāśārivāvrahmīkuṣṭhasaindhavasiddhaṃ sarppiḥ pātuṃ prayacchet | kṣīrānnād asya madhukavacātriphalāsiddhaṃ | annād asya dvipañcamūlīkṣīratagarabhadradāruviḍaṅga- drākṣādisiddhaṃ tena kumārasyārogyavalamedhāyūṃṣi bhavanti |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁kṣīrāhārāya A₁₉₃₁add sarpiḥ pāyayet A₁₉₃₁siddhārthakavacāmāṃsīpayasyāpāmārgaśatāvarīsārivābrāhmīpippapīharidrākuṣ° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁kṣīrānnādāya A₁₉₃₁madhukavacāpippalīcitrakatri° A₁₉₃₁annādāya A₁₉₃₁°rumaricamadhukaviḍaṅga-drākṣādvibrāhmīsiddaṃ ; A₁₉₃₁tenārogyabala° A₁₉₃₁śiśorbhavanti ||
1931 ed. 3.10.46 vālaṃ punar ggātreṣu na gṛṅṇīyāt | na cainaṃ tarjjayet sahasā vā na prabodhayed vitrāsabhayāt | sahasā nāhared utkṣiped vātābhighātabhayān nopaveśayet kauvjabhayān nityaṃ cainam anuvartteta priyahitair eva m abhihitamanādyamapyabhivarddhate nityamudagrasatvasampannastv arogo bhavati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁bālaṃ A₁₉₃₁gātrasukhaṃ A₁₉₃₁gṛhṇīyāt, A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁pratibo° A₁₉₃₁nāpaha° A₁₉₃₁add A₁₉₃₁vātādivighā° A₁₉₃₁kaubjyabha° A₁₉₃₁priyśatair A₁₉₃₁add ajighāṃsuḥ; A₁₉₃₁evam A₁₉₃₁anabhihatamanās tv abhi° A₁₉₃₁nityam udagrasat tv asaṃpanno nīrogaḥ suprasannamanāś ca bhavati | A₁₉₃₁add vātātapavidyutprabhāpādapalatāśūnyāgāranimnasthānagra(gṛ?)hacchāyādibhyo A₁₉₃₁durgrahopasargataś A₁₉₃₁add ca A₁₉₃₁add bālaṃ rakṣet || A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.10.47 bhavati cātra ||
nāśucau visṛjed vālaṃ nākāse viṣameṇa ca |
noṣṇamārutavarṣeṣu rajodhūmodakeṣu vā ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁bālaṃ A₁₉₃₁nākāśe A₁₉₃₁viṣame na A₁₉₃₁noṣmamā° A₁₉₃₁ca ||
1931 ed. 3.10.48 kṣīrasātmyatayākṣīramājaṃ gavyam athāpi vā |
dadyād astanyam aprāptau vālebhyo vīkṣya mātrayā ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°yā kṣīramājaṃ A₁₉₃₁āstanyaparyāpter A₁₉₃₁bālānāṃ
1931 ed. 3.10.49 ṣaṇmāsāc cainam annam prāśayel laghuhitaṃ
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁ṣaṇmāsaṃ A₁₉₃₁cainamannaṃ A₁₉₃₁laghu hitaṃ A₁₉₃₁add ca ||
1931 ed. 3.10.50 nityam avarodhaś ca | syāt kṛtarakṣaḥ | upasarggabhayā grahopasarggebhyo rakṣyā vālā bhavanti ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁avarodharataś A₁₉₃₁°yāt; prayatnataś ca A₁₉₃₁bālā
1931 ed. 3.10.51 atha kumāra udvijate trasyati roditi naṣṭasaṃjño bhavati || nakhadaśanair ddhātrīm ātmānañ ca paritudati dantān khādati kūjati jṛmbhate bhrūvāvutkṣipaty ūrddhvan nirīkṣate phenam udvamati sandaṣṭauṣṭhaḥ krūrabhinnārttasvaro niśi jāgartti durvvalomnāṅgo yathāpūrvvaṃ dhātryāḥ stanyan nābhilaṣatīti sāmānyaṃ grahopasṛṣṭalakṣaṇ uktaṃ | vistareṇotta re vakṣyāmaḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°śanairghātrīmātmānaṃ A₁₉₃₁pariṇudati A₁₉₃₁bhruvau vikṣipaty A₁₉₃₁ūrdhvaṃ A₁₉₃₁kūro bhinnāmavarcā dīnā° A₁₉₃₁durbalo mlānāṅgo A₁₉₃₁add matsyaccahucchrundarimatkuṇagandho A₁₉₃₁yathā purā A₁₉₃₁stanyam A₁₉₃₁add abhilaṣati tathā A₁₉₃₁sāmānyena A₁₉₃₁°kṣaṇam A₁₉₃₁vistareṇottare
1931 ed. 3.10.52 śaktimantaṃ cainaṃ jñātvā yathā svam vidyāṃ grāhayet |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁yathāvarṇaṃ
1931 ed. 3.10.53 athāsmai pañcaviṃśativarṣāya ṣoḍaśavarṣām patnīm āvahen mitradharmmārthakāmaprajāḥ prāpsyāmīti ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁dvādaśa° A₁₉₃₁āvahet A₁₉₃₁pitryadha° A₁₉₃₁prāpsyatīti ||
1931 ed. 3.10.54 bhavati cātra || ūnaṣoḍaśavarṣāyām aprāptaḥ pañcaviṃśatiḥ | yadyādhatte pumān garbhaḥ kukṣisthaḥ savipadyate |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁°śatim || A₁₉₃₁yady ādhatte A₁₉₃₁umān A₁₉₃₁garbhaṃ Hgarvbhaḥ A₁₉₃₁sa vi°
1931 ed. 3.10.55 jātovā ni ciraṃ jīved vā durvvalendriyaḥ |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁jāto vā A₁₉₃₁na A₁₉₃₁add jīved A₁₉₃₁durbalen° A₁₉₃₁add tasmād atyantabālāyāṃ garbhādhānaṃ na kārayet ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add ativṛddhāyāṃ dīrgharogiṇyām anyena vā vikāreṇopasṛṣṭāyāṃ garbhādhānaṃ naiva kurvīta | puruṣasyāpy evaṃvidhasya ta eva doṣāḥ saṃbhavanti ||
1931 ed. 3.10.57 tatra pūrvoktaiḥ kāraṇaiḥ prapatiṣyati garbha | garvbhāsayaśroṇīvaṃkṣaṇavastiśūlāni bhavanti | raktadarśanañ ca | tāsām pariṣekāvagāhālepanair upacaret kṣīrapānaiś ca | alpālpasyandate kṣīramutpalādi siddham vā pāyayet | saṃsramāne savātapārśvaśūlānāha mūtrasaṅgāḥ sthānāt sthānaṃ cotkrāmati garbhaḥ | tatra snigdhaṃ śītāḥ kriyāḥ | vedanāyāṃ mahāsahamadhukasvadaṃṣṭrakaṇṭakārikāsiddha payaḥ | kṣaudraśarkarāmiśram pāyayet | mūtrasaṅge darvbhādisiddhaṃ | ānāhe hiṃgusauvarccalaraso na siddhaṃ sravati rakte koṣṭhāt kaṇṭakārikāmṛtpiṇḍagairikasarjjarasāñjanacūrṇṇa yathālābhaṃnyagrodhāditvakpravālakalkan vā pāyayet | utpalādikase di siddham vā | vṛhatīdvayotpalaśārivāpayasyāmadhukasiddham vā | etenopavarttate rujasu garbhaś cāpy āyyate || māsānumāsikam vyavasthivyenodumvaraśalāṭusiddhena payasā bhojayet | atīte lavaṇaṃ varjyābhir uddālukādīnāṃ pācanīyopasaṃbhṛtābhir upakrāmet yāvanto māsā garbhasya tāvantyahāni vastyudaraśūle purāṇaguḍan dīpanīyasaṃyuktam pāyayed ariṣṭam vā | vātātapaśramasevinyā vātopahīhītatvāt srotasāṃ līyate garbhaḥ sotikālam avatiṣṭhamāno vyāpadyate | tāṃ mṛdunā snehādinā krameṇopacaret | utkrosarasaṃ yavāgūñ cālpasnehām prayacchet | kālātītasthāyini garbhaviśeṣato dhānyam udūkhalamusalenābhihanyāt | viṣamam vā yānāsanam upasevet | vātābhipanna eva śuṣyati garbhaḥ samātuḥ kukṣin na pūrayati | mandaṃ spandate ca taṃ vṛṃhaṇīyaḥ payobhir mmāṃsarasaiś copacaret | śukraśoṇitaṃ vāyunoparuddham anavaktrāntajīvam ādhmāpayatyudaran tat kadācid yadṛcchayopaśāntan naigameṣā pahṛtam iti vadanti | tam eva kadācit pravilīyamānam āpūryamāṇam vā nāgodaram ity āhus tatrāpi līnavat pratikāraḥ | nivṛttaprasavāyāḥ punaḥ ṣaḍbhyo varṣebhya ūrddhvam prasavatyāḥ kumāro 'lpāyur bhavati |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁om pra° A₁₉₃₁garbhe Hgarvbha | A₁₉₃₁garbhāśayakaṭīvaṅkṣaṇabasti° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁tatra A₁₉₃₁add śītaiḥ A₁₉₃₁°gāhapradehādibhir A₁₉₃₁upacarejjīvanīyaśṛtakṣī° A₁₉₃₁add ca; A₁₉₃₁garbhasphuraṇe A₁₉₃₁add muhurmuhus tat sandhāraṇārthaṃ A₁₉₃₁kṣīram utpalādisiddhaṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁prasraṃsamāne A₁₉₃₁sadāhapārśvapṛṣṭhaśūlāsṛgdarānāhamū° A₁₉₃₁copakrāmati A₁₉₃₁garbhe koṣṭhe saṃrambhaḥ, Hgarvbhaḥ | A₁₉₃₁snigdhaśītāḥ A₁₉₃₁mahāsahākṣudrasahāmadhukaśvadaṃṣṭrākaṇṭakārikāsiddhaṃ A₁₉₃₁śarkarākṣaudramiśraṃ A₁₉₃₁darbhādi° A₁₉₃₁°lalaśunavacāsiddhaṃ; A₁₉₃₁add atyarthaṃ A₁₉₃₁koṣṭhāgārikāgāramṛtpiṇḍasamaṅgādhātakīkusumanavamālikāgairikasarjarasarasāñjanacūrṇaṃ madhunā 'valihyāt, A₁₉₃₁°bhaṃ nyagrodhāditvakpravālakalkaṃ A₁₉₃₁add payasā A₁₉₃₁°kalkaṃ vā kaśeruśṛṅgāṭakaśālūkakalkaṃ vā śṛtena payasā, A₁₉₃₁add udumbaraphalaudakakandakvāthena A₁₉₃₁ A₁₉₃₁add śarkarābhadhumadhureṇa śālipiṣṭaṃ, A₁₉₃₁nyagrodhādisvarasaparipītaṃ A₁₉₃₁add vā vastrāvayavaṃ yonyāṃ dhārayet; athādṛṣṭaśoṇitavedanāyāṃ A₁₉₃₁madhukadevadārumañjiṣṭhāpayasyāsiddhaṃ payaḥ pāyayet, A₁₉₃₁add tad evāśmantakaśatāvarīpayasyāsiddhaṃ vidārigandhādisiddhaṃ vā, A₁₉₃₁bṛhatīdvayotpalaśatāvarīsāri° A₁₉₃₁add evaṃ kṣipram A₁₉₃₁upakrāntāyā upāvartante A₁₉₃₁rujo Hgarvbhaś A₁₉₃₁āyate; A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁vyavasthite ca garbhe gavyenoḍumbara° A₁₉₃₁lavaṇasnehava° A₁₉₃₁add yavāgūbhir A₁₉₃₁uddālakā° A₁₉₃₁°saṃskṛtābhir A₁₉₃₁upakrameta Hgarvbhasya A₁₉₃₁tāvanty ahāni; A₁₉₃₁bastyudaraśūleṣu A₁₉₃₁°guḍaṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁vātopadravagṛhī° Hgarvbhaḥ A₁₉₃₁so 'ti° A₁₉₃₁snehādikra° A₁₉₃₁utkrośarasasaṃśsiddhām A₁₉₃₁add analpasnehāṃ A₁₉₃₁add pāyayet, A₁₉₃₁māṣatilabilvaśalāṭusiddhān A₁₉₃₁add vā kulmāṣān bhakṣayen madhumādhvīkaṃ A₁₉₃₁cānupibet A₁₉₃₁add saptarātraṃ; Hgarvbhavi° A₁₉₃₁garbhe vi° A₁₉₃₁sadhānyam A₁₉₃₁udūkhalaṃ mu° A₁₉₃₁viṣame A₁₉₃₁yān āsane A₁₉₃₁seveta; Hgarvbhaḥ A₁₉₃₁sa mātuḥ A₁₉₃₁kukṣiṃ A₁₉₃₁bṛṃhaṇīyaiḥ A₁₉₃₁copacaret; śukra° A₁₉₃₁vāyunā 'bhiprapannam A₁₉₃₁avakrānta° A₁₉₃₁°yaty udaraṃ, A₁₉₃₁taṃ A₁₉₃₁°śāntaṃ A₁₉₃₁°ṣāpahṛtam A₁₉₃₁bhāṣante, A₁₉₃₁pralī° A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁pratīkāraḥ || A₁₉₃₁om Hvbhavati |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add ata ūrdhvaṃ māsānumāsikaṃ vakṣyāmaḥ ||
1931 ed. 3.10.59 madhakuṃ śālivījañ ca payasyā suradāru ca |
aśmantakaḥ kṛṣṇatilās tāmravallī śatāvarī ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁madhukaṃ A₁₉₃₁śākabījaṃ A₁₉₃₁add tilāḥ A₁₉₃₁kṛṣṇās
1931 ed. 3.10.60 vṛkṣādanī payasyā ca latā sotpalaśārivā |
anantā śārivā rāsnā padmam madhukam eva ca ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁sotpalasārivā || A₁₉₃₁sārivā A₁₉₃₁padmā
1931 ed. 3.10.61 vṛhatīdvayakāśmaryakṣīrīśuṃgātvaco ghṛtaṃ |
pṛthakparṇṇī valā śigra śvadaṃṣṭrā madhuyaṣṭikā ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁bṛhatyau kāśmarī cāpi kṣīriśuṅgās tvaco A₁₉₃₁pṛśniparṇī A₁₉₃₁balā A₁₉₃₁śigru A₁₉₃₁madhuparṇikā ||
1931 ed. 3.10.62 śṛṅgāṭakamvisaṃ drākṣā kaseru madhukaṃ sitā |
vatsaite saptayogāḥ syur arddhaślokasamāpanāḥ ||
yathākramaṃ prayoktavyā garbhasrāve payoyutāḥ |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁śṛṅgāṭakaṃ bisaṃ A₁₉₃₁kaśeru A₁₉₃₁sapta yogāḥ A₁₉₃₁yathāsaṃkhyaṃ Hgarvbhasrāve
kapitthavilvavṛhatīpaṭolekṣunidigdhikā ||
mūlāni kṣīrasiddhāni pāyayed bhiṣag aṣṭame |
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁kapitthabṛhatībilvapa°
1931 ed. 3.10.64 navame madhukānantā payasyāśārivām pivet ||
payas tu śritaśītam praśasyate ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁°tāpayasyāsārivāḥ A₁₉₃₁pibet || A₁₉₃₁add kṣīraṃ A₁₉₃₁śuṇṭhīpayasyābhyāṃ A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁siddhaṃ A₁₉₃₁syād daśame A₁₉₃₁add hitam ||
1931 ed. 3.10.65 sakṣīrā vā hitā śuṇṭhī madhukaṃ devadāru ca |
evam apyāyyate garbhas tīvrā ruk copaśāmyati ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁suradāru A₁₉₃₁āpyāyate Hgarvbhas
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add nivṛttaprasavāyās tu punaḥ ṣaḍbhyo varṣebhya ūrdhvaṃ prasavam ānāyā nāryāḥ kumāro 'lpāyur bhavati ||
1931 ed. 3.10.67 atha garvbhiṇī vyādhyutpannāvātyayec charddayen madhurāmlenānnopahitena | anulomayec ca saṃśamanīyam mṛdu vidadhyāt | annapānayor iti | aśnīyāc ca mṛduvīryaṅ garvbhāviruddhām̐ś ca kriyāyogān vidadhīta iti ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁garbhiṇīṃ A₁₉₃₁vyādhyutpattāv atyaye cha° A₁₉₃₁add ca A₁₉₃₁om A₁₉₃₁madhuraprāyaṃ A₁₉₃₁add garbhāviruddhaṃ ca, A₁₉₃₁garbhāviruddhāś A₁₉₃₁yathāyogaṃ A₁₉₃₁add mṛdu prāyāḥ || A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.10.68 suvarṇṇaṃ rṇṇacūsukṛdaṃ kuṣṭham madhuvacā ghṛtaṃ |
matsyākṣakaḥśaṃkhapuṣpī sarppiḥ kāñcanam eva ca ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁add bhavanti cātra | A₁₉₃₁sauvarṇaṃ A₁₉₃₁sukṛtaṃ A₁₉₃₁add cūrṇaṃ A₁₉₃₁madhu A₁₉₃₁add vacā || A₁₉₃₁matsyākṣakaḥ śaṅ° A₁₉₃₁add madhu A₁₉₃₁sakāñ° A₁₉₃₁om
1931 ed. 3.10.69 arkkapuṣpī madhughṛtaṃ cūrṇṇitaṃ kanakan tathā |
suvarṇṇacūrṇṇavaiḍūryaṃ svetā dūrvvā ghṛtam madhuḥ ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁vacā || A₁₉₃₁hemacūrṇāni kaiḍaryaḥ A₁₉₃₁śvetā A₁₉₃₁madhu ||
1931 ed. 3.10.70 catvāro 'bhihitāḥ prāsyā arddhaślokasamāpanāḥ |
kumārāṇām vapur mmedhā valārogyakarāḥ śubhā iti ||
K, N, L A₁₉₃₁prāśāḥ A₁₉₃₁ślokārdheṣu caturṣv api || A₁₉₃₁vapurmedhā A₁₉₃₁balabuddhivivardhanāḥ || A₁₉₃₁om

iti garvbhiṇīvyākaraṇaṃ śārīre daśamo 'dhyāyaḥ || o ||

1931 ed. 3.10.70.1 bhūtacintā śukraśuddhiṃ garbhasaṅkramaṇan tathā |
garbhavyākaraṇañ caiva kāyavyākaraṇañ ca yat ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L Hgarvbhasaṅ° Hgarvbhavyā°
1931 ed. 3.10.70.2 marmmasirāvibhaktiś ca sirātāḍanam eva ca |
dhamanīvyākaraṇa caiva garvbhiṇyāpūryate daśa ||
A₁₉₃₁, K, N, L

|| iti śārīrasthānaṃ samāptaṃ ||